Dynamic TLS section symbols
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 typedef enum split16_format_type
41 {
42 split16a_type = 0,
43 split16d_type
44 }
45 split16_format_type;
46
47 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53
54 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60
61 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 section. */
63 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64
65 /* For old-style PLT. */
66 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68
69 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 ((4*4 \
73 + (h != NULL \
74 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78
79 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80
81 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 {
86 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 };
95 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 {
98 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 };
107
108 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 {
113 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 };
122 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 {
125 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 };
134
135 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137
138 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 a shared library. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145
146 /* Some instructions. */
147 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 #define B 0x48000000
155 #define BA 0x48000002
156 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 #define NOP 0x60000000
177 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178
179 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182
183 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 \f
189 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
190 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
191 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
192 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
193 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
194 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
195 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
196 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
197 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
198 complain, special_func) \
199 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
200 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
201 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
202
203 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
204
205 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
206 /* This reloc does nothing. */
207 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
208 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
209
210 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
211 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213
214 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
215 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
216 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
217 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
218
219 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
220 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
221 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222
223 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
224 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
225 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226
227 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
228 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
229 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230
231 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
232 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
233 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
234 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
235
236 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
237 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
238 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
239 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
240
241 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
242 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
243 bits must be zero. */
244 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
245 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
246
247 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
248 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
249 two bits must be zero. */
250 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
252
253 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
254 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
255 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256
257 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260
261 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
262 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
263 zero. */
264 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
265 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
266
267 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
268 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
269 be zero. */
270 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
271 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
272
273 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
274 symbol. */
275 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
276 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
277
278 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
279 the symbol. */
280 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
281 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
282
283 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
284 the symbol. */
285 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
286 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
287
288 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
289 the symbol. */
290 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
291 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
292
293 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
294 entry for the symbol. */
295 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
296 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
297
298 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
299 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
300 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
301 shared library into the object, because the object being
302 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
303 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
304 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
305
306 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
307 entries. */
308 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
309 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
310
311 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
312 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314
315 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
316 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
317 addend. */
318 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
322 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
323 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
324 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
328 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
332 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* 32-bit PC relative */
336 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
337 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338
339 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
340 FIXME: not supported. */
341 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
342 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
343
344 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
345 FIXME: not supported. */
346 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
347 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
348
349 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
350 the symbol. */
351 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
352 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
353
354 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
355 the symbol. */
356 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
357 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
358
359 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
360 the symbol. */
361 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
362 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
363
364 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
365 small data items. */
366 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
367 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
368
369 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
370 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372
373 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
374 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
375 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376
377 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
378 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
379 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380
381 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
382 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
386 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
387 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
388
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
396 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
403 definition of its TLS sym. */
404 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
405 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
406
407 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
408 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
409 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
410 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
414 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
415 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416
417 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
418 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
422 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
423 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424
425 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
426 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428
429 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
430 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
431 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
432 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
433
434 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
435 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
436 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437
438 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
439 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
440 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
443 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
444 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
447 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
451 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
452 to the first entry. */
453 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
457 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
458 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
461 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
462 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463
464 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
465 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
469 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
470 first entry. */
471 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
472 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
473
474 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
475 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
476 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477
478 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
479 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
480 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481
482 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
483 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485
486 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
487 the offset to the entry. */
488 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
489 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
490
491 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
492 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494
495 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
496 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
497 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498
499 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
500 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502
503 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
504 offset to the entry. */
505 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
506 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
507
508 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
509 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
510 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511
512 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
513 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
517 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519
520 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
521 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
522
523 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
524 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
525 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
529 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530
531 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
533 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534
535 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
536 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
537 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538
539 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
540 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
541 is negative. */
542 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
543 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
546 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
547 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
548 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
549 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
550
551 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
552 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
553 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
554 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
555 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
556
557 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
558 small data items. */
559 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
560 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
563 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
564 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
565 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
569 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
570 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
574
575 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
576 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
577 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
578 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
579 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
580
581 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
582 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
583 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
584
585 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
586 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
587 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588
589 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
590 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592
593 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
594 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
595 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
596
597 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
598 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600
601 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
602 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
603 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604
605 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
606 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608
609 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
610 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612
613 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
614 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616
617 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
618 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
619 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
620 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
621 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
622
623 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
624 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
625 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
628 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630
631 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
632 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634
635 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
636 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
637 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638
639 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
640 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642
643 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
644 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646
647 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
648 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* e_li split20 format. */
652 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
653 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654
655 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
659 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
660 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
661
662 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
664 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665
666 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
667 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
668 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669
670 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
671 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
672 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
673 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
674
675 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
676 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
677 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678
679 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
680 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
681 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682
683 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
684 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
685 NULL),
686
687 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
688 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 NULL),
690
691 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
692 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
693 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
694 };
695 \f
696 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
697
698 static void
699 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
700 {
701 unsigned int i, type;
702
703 for (i = 0;
704 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
705 i++)
706 {
707 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
708 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
709 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
710 abort ();
711 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
712 }
713 }
714
715 static reloc_howto_type *
716 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
717 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
718 {
719 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
720
721 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
722 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
723 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
724
725 switch (code)
726 {
727 default:
728 return NULL;
729
730 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
731 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
732 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
733 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
734 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
736 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
747 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
749 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
760 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
765 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
767 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
772 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
835 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
836 break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
854 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
860 }
861
862 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
863 };
864
865 static reloc_howto_type *
866 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
867 const char *r_name)
868 {
869 unsigned int i;
870
871 for (i = 0;
872 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
873 i++)
874 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
875 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
876 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
877
878 return NULL;
879 }
880
881 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
882
883 static bfd_boolean
884 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
885 arelent *cache_ptr,
886 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
887 {
888 unsigned int r_type;
889
890 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
891 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
892 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
893
894 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
895 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
896 {
897 /* xgettext:c-format */
898 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
899 abfd, r_type);
900 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
901 return FALSE;
902 }
903
904 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
905
906 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
907 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
908 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
909 {
910 /* xgettext:c-format */
911 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
912 abfd, r_type);
913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
914
915 return FALSE;
916 }
917
918 return TRUE;
919 }
920
921 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
922
923 static bfd_reloc_status_type
924 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
925 arelent *reloc_entry,
926 asymbol *symbol,
927 void *data,
928 asection *input_section,
929 bfd *output_bfd,
930 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
931 {
932 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
933 long insn;
934 bfd_size_type octets;
935 bfd_vma value;
936
937 if (output_bfd != NULL)
938 {
939 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
940 return bfd_reloc_ok;
941 }
942
943 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
944 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
945 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
946 return bfd_reloc_continue;
947
948 value = 0;
949 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
950 value = symbol->value;
951 value += (reloc_entry->addend
952 + symbol->section->output_offset
953 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
954 value -= (reloc_entry->address
955 + input_section->output_offset
956 + input_section->output_section->vma);
957 value >>= 16;
958
959 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
960 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
961 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
962 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
963 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 return bfd_reloc_ok;
965 }
966
967 static bfd_reloc_status_type
968 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
969 arelent *reloc_entry,
970 asymbol *symbol,
971 void *data,
972 asection *input_section,
973 bfd *output_bfd,
974 char **error_message)
975 {
976 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
977 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
978 link time. */
979 if (output_bfd != NULL)
980 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
981 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
982
983 if (error_message != NULL)
984 {
985 static char buf[60];
986 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
987 reloc_entry->howto->name);
988 *error_message = buf;
989 }
990 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
991 }
992 \f
993 /* Sections created by the linker. */
994
995 typedef struct elf_linker_section
996 {
997 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
998 asection *section;
999 /* Section name. */
1000 const char *name;
1001 /* Associated bss section name. */
1002 const char *bss_name;
1003 /* Associated symbol name. */
1004 const char *sym_name;
1005 /* Associated symbol. */
1006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1007 } elf_linker_section_t;
1008
1009 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1010 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1011 based on different addend's. */
1012
1013 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1014 {
1015 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1016 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1017 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1018 bfd_vma offset;
1019 /* addend used */
1020 bfd_vma addend;
1021 /* which linker section this is */
1022 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1023 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1024
1025 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1026 {
1027 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1028
1029 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1030 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1031 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1032
1033 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1034 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1035 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1036 };
1037
1038 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1039 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1040
1041 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1042 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1043
1044 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1045 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1046 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1047
1048 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1049
1050 static bfd_boolean
1051 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1054 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1058
1059 bfd_boolean
1060 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1061 {
1062 unsigned long mach = 0;
1063 asection *s;
1064 unsigned char *contents;
1065
1066 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1067 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1068 {
1069
1070 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1071 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1072 break;
1073 if (s != NULL)
1074 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1075 }
1076
1077 if (mach == 0)
1078 {
1079 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1080 if (s != NULL
1081 && s->size >= 24
1082 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1083 {
1084 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1085 unsigned int i;
1086
1087 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1088 {
1089 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1090 switch (val >> 16)
1091 {
1092 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1093 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1094 if (mach == 0)
1095 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1096 break;
1097
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1099 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1100 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1101 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1102 break;
1103
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1105 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1106 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1107 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1108 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1109 break;
1110
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1112 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1113 break;
1114
1115 default:
1116 mach = -1ul;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 free (contents);
1120 }
1121 }
1122
1123 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1124 {
1125 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1126
1127 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1128 if (arch->mach == mach)
1129 {
1130 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1131 break;
1132 }
1133 }
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1138 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1139
1140 static bfd_boolean
1141 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1142 {
1143 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1144 return TRUE;
1145
1146 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1147 {
1148 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1149
1150 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1151 {
1152 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1153 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1154 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1155 }
1156 }
1157 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1161
1162 static bfd_boolean
1163 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1164 {
1165 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1166 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1167
1168 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1169 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1170 return TRUE;
1171 }
1172
1173 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1174
1175 static bfd_boolean
1176 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1177 {
1178 int offset;
1179 unsigned int size;
1180
1181 switch (note->descsz)
1182 {
1183 default:
1184 return FALSE;
1185
1186 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1187 /* pr_cursig */
1188 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1189
1190 /* pr_pid */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1192
1193 /* pr_reg */
1194 offset = 72;
1195 size = 192;
1196
1197 break;
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1201 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1202 size, note->descpos + offset);
1203 }
1204
1205 static bfd_boolean
1206 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1207 {
1208 switch (note->descsz)
1209 {
1210 default:
1211 return FALSE;
1212
1213 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1214 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1215 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1216 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1217 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1218 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1219 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1223 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1224 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1225
1226 {
1227 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1228 int n = strlen (command);
1229
1230 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1231 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1232 }
1233
1234 return TRUE;
1235 }
1236
1237 static char *
1238 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1239 {
1240 switch (note_type)
1241 {
1242 default:
1243 return NULL;
1244
1245 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1246 {
1247 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1248 va_list ap;
1249
1250 va_start (ap, note_type);
1251 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1252 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1253 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1254 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1255 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1256 -Wstringop-truncation:
1257 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1258 */
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1260 #endif
1261 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1262 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1263 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1264 #endif
1265 va_end (ap);
1266 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1267 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1268 }
1269
1270 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1271 {
1272 char data[268];
1273 va_list ap;
1274 long pid;
1275 int cursig;
1276 const void *greg;
1277
1278 va_start (ap, note_type);
1279 memset (data, 0, 72);
1280 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1281 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1282 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1283 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1284 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1285 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1286 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1287 va_end (ap);
1288 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1289 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1290 }
1291 }
1292 }
1293
1294 static flagword
1295 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1296 {
1297
1298 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1299 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1300
1301 return 0;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1305 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1306
1307 static bfd_vma
1308 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 const arelent *rel)
1311 {
1312 return rel->address;
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1316 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1317 type. */
1318
1319 static bfd_boolean
1320 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1322 const char *name,
1323 int shindex)
1324 {
1325 asection *newsect;
1326 flagword flags;
1327
1328 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1329 return FALSE;
1330
1331 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1332 flags = bfd_get_section_flags (abfd, newsect);
1333 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1334 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1335
1336 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1337 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1338
1339 bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags);
1340 return TRUE;
1341 }
1342
1343 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1344
1345 static bfd_boolean
1346 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1348 asection *asect)
1349 {
1350 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1351 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1352
1353 return TRUE;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1357 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1358
1359 static int
1360 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1361 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1362 {
1363 asection *s;
1364 int ret = 0;
1365
1366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1367 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1368 ++ret;
1369
1370 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1371 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1372 ++ret;
1373
1374 return ret;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1378
1379 bfd_boolean
1380 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1381 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1382 {
1383 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1384
1385 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1386 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1387 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1388 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1389 We maintain the original output section order. */
1390
1391 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1392 {
1393 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1394 bfd_size_type amt;
1395 unsigned int j, k;
1396 unsigned int p_flags;
1397
1398 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1399 continue;
1400
1401 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1402 {
1403 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1404 p_flags |= PF_W;
1405 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1406 {
1407 p_flags |= PF_X;
1408 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1409 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1410 break;
1411 }
1412 }
1413 if (j != m->count)
1414 while (++j != m->count)
1415 {
1416 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1417
1418 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1419 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1420 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1421 {
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1423 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1424 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1425 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 break;
1427 }
1428 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1429 }
1430 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1431 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1432 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1433 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1434 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1435 {
1436 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1437 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1438 }
1439 if (j == m->count)
1440 continue;
1441
1442 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1443 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1444 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1445
1446 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1447 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1448 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1449 if (n == NULL)
1450 return FALSE;
1451
1452 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1453 n->count = m->count - j;
1454 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1455 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1456 m->count = j;
1457 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1458 n->next = m->next;
1459 m->next = n;
1460 }
1461
1462 return TRUE;
1463 }
1464
1465 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1466 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1467 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1468 2 sections. */
1469
1470 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1471 {
1472 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1473 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1474 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1482 };
1483
1484 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1485 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1487
1488 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1489 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1490 {
1491 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1492
1493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1494 if (sec->name == NULL)
1495 return NULL;
1496
1497 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1498 sec->use_rela_p);
1499 if (ssect != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1502 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1503 return ssect;
1504 }
1505
1506 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1507 }
1508 \f
1509 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1510 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1511 {
1512 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1513 unsigned long value;
1514 }
1515 apuinfo_list;
1516
1517 static apuinfo_list *head;
1518 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1519
1520 static void
1521 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1522 {
1523 head = NULL;
1524 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1525 }
1526
1527 static void
1528 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1529 {
1530 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1531
1532 while (entry != NULL)
1533 {
1534 if (entry->value == value)
1535 return;
1536 entry = entry->next;
1537 }
1538
1539 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1540 if (entry == NULL)
1541 return;
1542
1543 entry->value = value;
1544 entry->next = head;
1545 head = entry;
1546 }
1547
1548 static unsigned
1549 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1550 {
1551 apuinfo_list *entry;
1552 unsigned long count;
1553
1554 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1555 entry;
1556 entry = entry->next)
1557 ++ count;
1558
1559 return count;
1560 }
1561
1562 static inline unsigned long
1563 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1564 {
1565 apuinfo_list * entry;
1566
1567 for (entry = head;
1568 entry && number --;
1569 entry = entry->next)
1570 ;
1571
1572 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1573 }
1574
1575 static void
1576 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1577 {
1578 apuinfo_list *entry;
1579
1580 for (entry = head; entry;)
1581 {
1582 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1583 free (entry);
1584 entry = next;
1585 }
1586
1587 head = NULL;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1591 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1595 {
1596 bfd *ibfd;
1597 asection *asec;
1598 char *buffer = NULL;
1599 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1600 unsigned i;
1601 unsigned long length;
1602 const char *error_message = NULL;
1603
1604 if (link_info == NULL)
1605 return;
1606
1607 apuinfo_list_init ();
1608
1609 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1610 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long datum;
1613
1614 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1615 if (asec == NULL)
1616 continue;
1617
1618 /* xgettext:c-format */
1619 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1620 length = asec->size;
1621 if (length < 20)
1622 goto fail;
1623
1624 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1625 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1626 {
1627 if (buffer)
1628 free (buffer);
1629 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1630 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1631 if (!buffer)
1632 return;
1633 }
1634
1635 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1636 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1637 {
1638 /* xgettext:c-format */
1639 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1640 goto fail;
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1644 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1645 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1646 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1647 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1648 goto fail;
1649
1650 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1651 if (datum != 0x2)
1652 goto fail;
1653
1654 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1659 if (datum + 20 != length)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1663 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1664 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1665 }
1666
1667 error_message = NULL;
1668
1669 if (apuinfo_set)
1670 {
1671 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1672 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1673
1674 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1675 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1676
1677 if (asec && ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1678 {
1679 ibfd = abfd;
1680 /* xgettext:c-format */
1681 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 fail:
1686 if (buffer)
1687 free (buffer);
1688
1689 if (error_message)
1690 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1694 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1695
1696 static bfd_boolean
1697 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1698 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1699 asection *asec,
1700 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1701 {
1702 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1706
1707 static void
1708 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1709 {
1710 bfd_byte *buffer;
1711 asection *asec;
1712 unsigned i;
1713 unsigned num_entries;
1714 bfd_size_type length;
1715
1716 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1717 if (asec == NULL)
1718 return;
1719
1720 if (!apuinfo_set)
1721 return;
1722
1723 length = asec->size;
1724 if (length < 20)
1725 return;
1726
1727 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1728 if (buffer == NULL)
1729 {
1730 _bfd_error_handler
1731 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1732 return;
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1736 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1737 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1738 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1740 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1741
1742 length = 20;
1743 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1744 {
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1746 length += 4;
1747 }
1748
1749 if (length != asec->size)
1750 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1751
1752 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 free (buffer);
1756
1757 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1758 }
1759 \f
1760 static bfd_boolean
1761 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1762 {
1763 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1764
1765 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1766 return FALSE;
1767
1768 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1769 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1770 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1771 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1772 }
1773
1774 static bfd_boolean
1775 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1776 {
1777 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1778 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1779 && section->vma <= vma
1780 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1781 }
1782
1783 static long
1784 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1785 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1786 asymbol **ret)
1787 {
1788 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1789 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1790 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1791 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1792 bfd_vma stub_off;
1793 asymbol *s;
1794 arelent *p;
1795 long count, i, stub_delta;
1796 size_t size;
1797 char *names;
1798 bfd_byte buf[4];
1799
1800 *ret = NULL;
1801
1802 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1803 return 0;
1804
1805 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1806 return 0;
1807
1808 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1809 if (relplt == NULL)
1810 return 0;
1811
1812 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1813 if (plt == NULL)
1814 return 0;
1815
1816 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1817 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1818 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1819 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1820
1821 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1822 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1823 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1824 if (dynamic != NULL)
1825 {
1826 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1827 size_t extdynsize;
1828 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1829
1830 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1831 return -1;
1832
1833 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1834 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1835
1836 extdyn = dynbuf;
1837 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1838 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1839 {
1840 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1841 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1842
1843 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1844 break;
1845
1846 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1847 {
1848 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1849 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1850 if (got != NULL
1851 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1852 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1853 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1854 break;
1855 }
1856 }
1857 free (dynbuf);
1858 }
1859
1860 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1861 if (glink_vma == 0)
1862 {
1863 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1864 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1865 }
1866
1867 if (glink_vma == 0)
1868 return 0;
1869
1870 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1871 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1872 glink stubs now reside. */
1873 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1874 if (glink == NULL)
1875 return 0;
1876
1877 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1878 from the first glink stub. */
1879 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1880 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1881 {
1882 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1883
1884 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1885 insn ^= B;
1886 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1887 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1888
1889 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1890 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1891 for (i = 4;
1892 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1893 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1894 i += 4)
1895 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1896 {
1897 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1898 break;
1899 }
1900 }
1901
1902 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1903 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1904 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1905 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1906 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1907 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1908 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1909 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1910 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1911 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1912 break;
1913 if (stub_delta > 32)
1914 return 0;
1915
1916 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1917 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1918 return -1;
1919
1920 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1921 p = relplt->relocation;
1922 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1923 {
1924 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1925 if (p->addend != 0)
1926 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1927 }
1928
1929 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1930
1931 if (resolv_vma)
1932 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1933
1934 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1935 if (s == NULL)
1936 return -1;
1937
1938 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1939 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1940 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1941 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1942 {
1943 size_t len;
1944
1945 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1946 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1947 stub_off -= 32;
1948 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1949 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1950 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1951 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1952 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1953 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1954 s->section = glink;
1955 s->value = stub_off;
1956 s->name = names;
1957 s->udata.p = NULL;
1958 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1959 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1960 names += len;
1961 if (p->addend != 0)
1962 {
1963 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1964 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1965 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1966 names += strlen (names);
1967 }
1968 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1969 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1970 ++s;
1971 --p;
1972 }
1973
1974 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1975 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1976 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1977 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1978 s->section = glink;
1979 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1980 s->name = names;
1981 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1982 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1983 s++;
1984 count++;
1985
1986 if (resolv_vma)
1987 {
1988 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1989 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1990 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1991 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1992 s->section = glink;
1993 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
1994 s->name = names;
1995 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
1996 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1997 s++;
1998 count++;
1999 }
2000
2001 return count;
2002 }
2003 \f
2004 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2005 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2006 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2007 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2008 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2009 called. */
2010
2011 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2012 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2013 struct plt_entry
2014 {
2015 struct plt_entry *next;
2016
2017 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2018 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2019 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2020 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2021 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2022 bfd_vma addend;
2023
2024 /* The .got2 section. */
2025 asection *sec;
2026
2027 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2028 union
2029 {
2030 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2031 bfd_vma offset;
2032 } plt;
2033
2034 /* .glink stub offset. */
2035 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2036 };
2037
2038 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2039 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2040 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2041
2042 static int
2043 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2044 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2045 {
2046 switch (r_type)
2047 {
2048 default:
2049 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2050 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2051 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2052 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2053 return 1;
2054
2055 case R_PPC_REL24:
2056 case R_PPC_REL14:
2057 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2058 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2059 case R_PPC_REL32:
2060 return 0;
2061
2062 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2063 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2064 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2065 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2066 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2067 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2068 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2069 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2070 }
2071 }
2072
2073 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2074 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2075 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2076 shared lib. */
2077 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2078
2079 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2080 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2081 {
2082 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2083
2084 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2085 asection *sec;
2086
2087 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2088 unsigned int count : 31;
2089
2090 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2091 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2092 };
2093
2094 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2095
2096 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2097 {
2098 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2099
2100 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2101 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2102 from the beginning of the section. */
2103 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2104
2105 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2106 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2107
2108 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2109 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2110 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2111 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2112 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2113 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2114 set TLS_TPRELGD when a GD reloc turns into a TPREL one. We use a
2115 separate flag rather than setting TPREL just for convenience in
2116 distinguishing the two cases.
2117 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2118 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2119 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2120 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2121 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2122 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2123 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2124 #define TLS_TPRELGD 64 /* TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2125 unsigned char tls_mask;
2126
2127 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2128 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2129 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2130 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2131 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2132
2133 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2134 symbol. */
2135 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2136
2137 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2138 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2139 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2140 };
2141
2142 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2143
2144 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2145
2146 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2147 {
2148 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2149
2150 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2151 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2152
2153 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2154 asection *glink;
2155 asection *dynsbss;
2156 asection *relsbss;
2157 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2158 asection *sbss;
2159 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2160 asection *pltlocal;
2161 asection *relpltlocal;
2162
2163 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2164 asection *srelplt2;
2165
2166 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2167 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2168
2169 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2170 bfd *old_bfd;
2171
2172 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2173 union {
2174 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2175 bfd_vma offset;
2176 } tlsld_got;
2177
2178 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2179 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2180
2181 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2182 unsigned int got_header_size;
2183 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2184 unsigned int got_gap;
2185
2186 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2187 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2188
2189 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2190 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2191
2192 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2193 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2194 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2195 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2196
2197 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2198 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2199
2200 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2201 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2202
2203 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2204 int plt_entry_size;
2205 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2206 int plt_slot_size;
2207 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2208 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2209
2210 /* Small local sym cache. */
2211 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2212 };
2213
2214 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2215 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2216
2217 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2218 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2219
2220 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr. */
2221 #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
2222
2223 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2224 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2225
2226 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2227
2228 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2229 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2230 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2231
2232 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2233
2234 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2235 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2236 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2237 const char *string)
2238 {
2239 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2240 subclass. */
2241 if (entry == NULL)
2242 {
2243 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2244 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2245 if (entry == NULL)
2246 return entry;
2247 }
2248
2249 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2250 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2251 if (entry != NULL)
2252 {
2253 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2254 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2255 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2256 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2257 }
2258
2259 return entry;
2260 }
2261
2262 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2263
2264 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2265 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2266 {
2267 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2268 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2269 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2270
2271 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2272 if (ret == NULL)
2273 return NULL;
2274
2275 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2276 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2277 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2278 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2279 {
2280 free (ret);
2281 return NULL;
2282 }
2283
2284 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2285 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2286 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2287 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2288
2289 ret->params = &default_params;
2290
2291 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2292 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2293 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2294
2295 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2296 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2297 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2298
2299 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2300 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2301 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2302
2303 return &ret->elf.root;
2304 }
2305
2306 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2307
2308 void
2309 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2310 {
2311 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2312
2313 if (htab)
2314 htab->params = params;
2315 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2316 }
2317
2318 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2319
2320 static bfd_boolean
2321 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2322 {
2323 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2324
2325 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2326 return FALSE;
2327
2328 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2329 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2330 {
2331 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2332 executable. */
2333 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2334 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2335 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2336 return FALSE;
2337 }
2338
2339 return TRUE;
2340 }
2341
2342 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2343 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2344 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2345
2346 static bfd_boolean
2347 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2348 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2349 flagword flags,
2350 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2351 {
2352 asection *s;
2353
2354 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2355 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2356
2357 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2358 if (s == NULL)
2359 return FALSE;
2360 lsect->section = s;
2361
2362 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2363 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2364
2365 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2366 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2367 return FALSE;
2368 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2369 return TRUE;
2370 }
2371
2372 static bfd_boolean
2373 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2374 {
2375 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2376 asection *s;
2377 flagword flags;
2378 int p2align;
2379
2380 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2381 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2382 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2383 htab->glink = s;
2384 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2385 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2386 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2387 if (s == NULL
2388 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, p2align))
2389 return FALSE;
2390
2391 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2392 {
2393 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2394 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2395 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2396 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2397 if (s == NULL
2398 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2399 return FALSE;
2400 }
2401
2402 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2403 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2404 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2405 if (s == NULL
2406 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
2407 return FALSE;
2408
2409 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2410 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2411 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2412 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2413 if (s == NULL
2414 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2415 return FALSE;
2416
2417 /* Local plt entries. */
2418 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2419 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2420 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2421 flags);
2422 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2423 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->pltlocal, 2))
2424 return FALSE;
2425
2426 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2427 {
2428 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2429 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2430 htab->relpltlocal
2431 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2432 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2433 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2434 return FALSE;
2435 }
2436
2437 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2438 &htab->sdata[0]))
2439 return FALSE;
2440
2441 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2442 &htab->sdata[1]))
2443 return FALSE;
2444
2445 return TRUE;
2446 }
2447
2448 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2449 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2450 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2451
2452 static bfd_boolean
2453 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2454 {
2455 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2456 asection *s;
2457 flagword flags;
2458
2459 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2460
2461 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2462 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2463 return FALSE;
2464
2465 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2466 return FALSE;
2467
2468 if (htab->glink == NULL
2469 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2470 return FALSE;
2471
2472 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2473 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2474 htab->dynsbss = s;
2475 if (s == NULL)
2476 return FALSE;
2477
2478 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2479 {
2480 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2481 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2482 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2483 htab->relsbss = s;
2484 if (s == NULL
2485 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2486 return FALSE;
2487 }
2488
2489 if (htab->is_vxworks
2490 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2491 return FALSE;
2492
2493 s = htab->elf.splt;
2494 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2495 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2496 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2497 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2498 return bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags);
2499 }
2500
2501 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2502
2503 static void
2504 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2505 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2506 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2507 {
2508 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2509
2510 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2511 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2512
2513 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2514 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2515
2516 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2517 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2518 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2519 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2520 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2521 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2522 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2523
2524 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2525 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2526 return;
2527
2528 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2529 {
2530 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2531 {
2532 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2533 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2534
2535 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2536 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2537 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2538 {
2539 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2540
2541 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2542 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2543 {
2544 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2545 q->count += p->count;
2546 *pp = p->next;
2547 break;
2548 }
2549 if (q == NULL)
2550 pp = &p->next;
2551 }
2552 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2553 }
2554
2555 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2556 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2557 }
2558
2559 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2560 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2561 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2562 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2563
2564 /* And plt entries. */
2565 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2566 {
2567 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2568 {
2569 struct plt_entry **entp;
2570 struct plt_entry *ent;
2571
2572 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2573 {
2574 struct plt_entry *dent;
2575
2576 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2577 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2578 {
2579 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2580 *entp = ent->next;
2581 break;
2582 }
2583 if (dent == NULL)
2584 entp = &ent->next;
2585 }
2586 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2587 }
2588
2589 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2590 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2591 }
2592
2593 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2594 {
2595 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2596 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2597 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2598 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2599 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2600 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2601 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2602 }
2603 }
2604
2605 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2606 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2607
2608 static bfd_boolean
2609 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2610 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2611 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2612 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2613 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2614 asection **secp,
2615 bfd_vma *valp)
2616 {
2617 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2618 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2619 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2620 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2621 {
2622 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2623 put into .sbss. */
2624 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2625
2626 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2627 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2628 {
2629 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2630
2631 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2632 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2633
2634 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2635 ".sbss",
2636 flags);
2637 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2638 return FALSE;
2639 }
2640
2641 *secp = htab->sbss;
2642 *valp = sym->st_size;
2643 }
2644
2645 return TRUE;
2646 }
2647 \f
2648 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2649
2650 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2651 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2652 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2653 bfd_vma addend,
2654 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2655 {
2656 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2657 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2658 return linker_pointers;
2659
2660 return NULL;
2661 }
2662
2663 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2664
2665 static bfd_boolean
2666 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2667 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2668 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2669 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2670 {
2671 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2672 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2673 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2674 bfd_size_type amt;
2675
2676 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2677
2678 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2679 if (h != NULL)
2680 {
2681 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2682
2683 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2684 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2685 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2686 rel->r_addend,
2687 lsect))
2688 return TRUE;
2689
2690 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2691 }
2692 else
2693 {
2694 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2695
2696 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2697 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2698
2699 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2700 if (!ptr)
2701 {
2702 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2703
2704 amt = num_symbols;
2705 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2706 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2707
2708 if (!ptr)
2709 return FALSE;
2710
2711 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2712 }
2713
2714 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2715 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2716 rel->r_addend,
2717 lsect))
2718 return TRUE;
2719
2720 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2721 }
2722
2723 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2724 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2725 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2726 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2727 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2728
2729 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2730 return FALSE;
2731
2732 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2733 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2734 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2735 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2736
2737 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section->owner, lsect->section, 2))
2738 return FALSE;
2739 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2740 lsect->section->size += 4;
2741
2742 #ifdef DEBUG
2743 fprintf (stderr,
2744 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2745 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2746 (long) lsect->section->size);
2747 #endif
2748
2749 return TRUE;
2750 }
2751
2752 static struct plt_entry **
2753 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2754 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2755 unsigned long r_symndx,
2756 int tls_type)
2757 {
2758 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2759 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2760 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2761
2762 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2763 {
2764 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2765
2766 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2767 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2768 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2769 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2770 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2771 return NULL;
2772 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2773 }
2774
2775 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2776 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2777 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2778 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2779 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2780 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2781 }
2782
2783 static bfd_boolean
2784 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2785 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2786 {
2787 struct plt_entry *ent;
2788
2789 if (addend < 32768)
2790 sec = NULL;
2791 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2792 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2793 break;
2794 if (ent == NULL)
2795 {
2796 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2797 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2798 if (ent == NULL)
2799 return FALSE;
2800 ent->next = *plist;
2801 ent->sec = sec;
2802 ent->addend = addend;
2803 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2804 *plist = ent;
2805 }
2806 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2807 return TRUE;
2808 }
2809
2810 static struct plt_entry *
2811 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2812 {
2813 struct plt_entry *ent;
2814
2815 if (addend < 32768)
2816 sec = NULL;
2817 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2818 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2819 break;
2820 return ent;
2821 }
2822
2823 static bfd_boolean
2824 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2825 {
2826 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2827 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2828 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2829 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2830 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2831 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2832 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2835 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2837 }
2838
2839 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2840
2841 static bfd_boolean
2842 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2843 {
2844 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2845 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2846 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2847 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2848 }
2849
2850 static void
2851 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2852 {
2853 _bfd_error_handler
2854 /* xgettext:c-format */
2855 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2856 abfd,
2857 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2858 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2859 }
2860
2861 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2862 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2863 table. */
2864
2865 static bfd_boolean
2866 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2867 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2868 asection *sec,
2869 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2870 {
2871 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2872 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2873 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2874 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2875 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2876 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2877 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2878
2879 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2880 return TRUE;
2881
2882 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2883 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2884 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2885 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2886 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2887 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2888 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2889 return TRUE;
2890
2891 #ifdef DEBUG
2892 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2893 sec, abfd);
2894 #endif
2895
2896 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2897
2898 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2899 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2900 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2901
2902 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2903 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2904 {
2905 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2906 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2907 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2908 return FALSE;
2909 }
2910 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2911 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2912 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2913 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2914 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2915 sreloc = NULL;
2916
2917 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2918 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2919 {
2920 unsigned long r_symndx;
2921 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2922 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2923 int tls_type;
2924 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2925 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2926 bfd_vma addend;
2927
2928 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2929 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2930 h = NULL;
2931 else
2932 {
2933 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2934 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2935 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2936 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2937 }
2938
2939 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2940 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2941 startup code. */
2942 if (h != NULL
2943 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2944 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2945 {
2946 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2947 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2948 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2949 return FALSE;
2950 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2951 }
2952
2953 tls_type = 0;
2954 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2955 ifunc = NULL;
2956 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2957 {
2958 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2959 abfd, r_symndx);
2960 if (isym == NULL)
2961 return FALSE;
2962
2963 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2964 {
2965 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2966 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2967 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2968 if (ifunc == NULL)
2969 return FALSE;
2970
2971 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2972 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2973 no plt calls. */
2974 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2975 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2976 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2977 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2978 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2979 {
2980 addend = 0;
2981 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2982 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2983 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2984 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2985 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2986 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2987 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2988 addend = rel->r_addend;
2989 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2990 return FALSE;
2991 }
2992 }
2993 }
2994
2995 if (!htab->is_vxworks
2996 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2997 && h != NULL
2998 && h == tga)
2999 {
3000 if (rel != relocs
3001 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3002 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3003 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3004 reloc. */
3005 ;
3006 else
3007 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3008 sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
3009 }
3010
3011 switch (r_type)
3012 {
3013 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3014 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3015 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3016 its parameter symbol. */
3017 if (h != NULL)
3018 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3019 else
3020 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3021 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3022 return FALSE;
3023 break;
3024
3025 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3026 break;
3027
3028 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3029 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3030 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3031 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3032 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3033 goto dogottls;
3034
3035 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3037 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3038 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3039 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3040 goto dogottls;
3041
3042 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3043 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3044 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3045 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3046 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3047 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3048 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3049 goto dogottls;
3050
3051 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3052 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3053 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3054 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3055 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3056 dogottls:
3057 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3058 /* Fall through. */
3059
3060 /* GOT16 relocations */
3061 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3062 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3063 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3064 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3065 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3066 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3067 {
3068 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3069 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3070 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3071 return FALSE;
3072 }
3073 if (h != NULL)
3074 {
3075 h->got.refcount += 1;
3076 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3077 }
3078 else
3079 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3080 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3081 return FALSE;
3082
3083 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3084 an ifunc. */
3085 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3086 {
3087 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3088 return FALSE;
3089 }
3090 break;
3091
3092 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3093 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3094 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3095 {
3096 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3097 return FALSE;
3098 }
3099 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3100 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3101 h, rel))
3102 return FALSE;
3103 if (h != NULL)
3104 {
3105 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3106 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3107 }
3108 break;
3109
3110 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3111 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3112 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3113 {
3114 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3115 return FALSE;
3116 }
3117 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3118 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3119 h, rel))
3120 return FALSE;
3121 if (h != NULL)
3122 {
3123 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3124 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3125 }
3126 break;
3127
3128 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3129 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3130 /* Fall through. */
3131
3132 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3133 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3134 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3135 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3136 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3138 if (h != NULL)
3139 {
3140 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3141 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3142 }
3143 break;
3144
3145 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3146 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3147 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3148 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3153 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3154 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3155 break;
3156
3157 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3158 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3159 {
3160 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3161 return FALSE;
3162 }
3163 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3164 if (h != NULL)
3165 {
3166 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3167 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3168 }
3169 break;
3170
3171 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3172 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3173 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3174 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3175 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3176 {
3177 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3178 return FALSE;
3179 }
3180 if (h != NULL)
3181 {
3182 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3183 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3184 }
3185 break;
3186
3187 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3188 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3189 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3190 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3191 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3192 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3193 {
3194 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3195 return FALSE;
3196 }
3197 if (h != NULL)
3198 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3199 break;
3200
3201 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3202 if (h == NULL)
3203 break;
3204 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3205 goto pltentry;
3206
3207 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3208 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3209 /* Fall through. */
3210
3211 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3212 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3213 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3214 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3215 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3216 pltentry:
3217 #ifdef DEBUG
3218 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3219 #endif
3220 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3221 if (h == NULL)
3222 {
3223 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3224 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3225 if (pltent == NULL)
3226 return FALSE;
3227 }
3228 else
3229 {
3230 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3231 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3232 h->needs_plt = 1;
3233 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3234 }
3235 addend = 0;
3236 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3237 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3238 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3239 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3240 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3241 addend = rel->r_addend;
3242 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3243 return FALSE;
3244 break;
3245
3246 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3247 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3248 section relative. */
3249 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3250 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3251 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3252 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3253 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3254 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3255 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3256 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3257 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3258 break;
3259
3260 case R_PPC_REL16:
3261 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3262 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3263 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3264 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3265 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3266 break;
3267
3268 /* These are just markers. */
3269 case R_PPC_TLS:
3270 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3271 case R_PPC_NONE:
3272 case R_PPC_max:
3273 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3274 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3275 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3276 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3277 break;
3278
3279 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3280 case R_PPC_COPY:
3281 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3282 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3283 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3284 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3285 break;
3286
3287 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3288 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3289 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3290 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3291 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3292 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3293 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3294 break;
3295
3296 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3297 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3298 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3299 {
3300 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3301 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3302 }
3303 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3304 {
3305 h->needs_plt = 1;
3306 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3307 return FALSE;
3308 }
3309 break;
3310
3311 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3312 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3313 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3314 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3315 return FALSE;
3316 break;
3317
3318 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3319 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3320 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3321 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3322 return FALSE;
3323 break;
3324
3325 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3326 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3327 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3328 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3329 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3330 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3331 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3332 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3333 goto dodyn;
3334
3335 /* Nor these. */
3336 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3337 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3338 goto dodyn;
3339
3340 case R_PPC_REL32:
3341 if (h == NULL
3342 && got2 != NULL
3343 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3344 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3345 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3346 {
3347 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3348 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3349 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3350 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3351 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3352 PLT call stubs. */
3353 asection *s;
3354 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3355
3356 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3357 abfd, r_symndx);
3358 if (isym == NULL)
3359 return FALSE;
3360
3361 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3362 if (s == got2)
3363 {
3364 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3365 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3366 }
3367 }
3368 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3369 break;
3370 /* fall through */
3371
3372 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3373 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3374 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3375 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3376 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3377 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3378 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3379 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3380 {
3381 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3382 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3383 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3384 return FALSE;
3385
3386 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3387 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3388 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3389 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3390 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3391 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3392 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3393 }
3394 goto dodyn;
3395
3396 case R_PPC_REL24:
3397 case R_PPC_REL14:
3398 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3399 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3400 if (h == NULL)
3401 break;
3402 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3403 {
3404 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3405 {
3406 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3407 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3408 }
3409 break;
3410 }
3411 /* fall through */
3412
3413 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3414 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3415 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3416 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3417 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3418 {
3419 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3420 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3421 h->needs_plt = 1;
3422 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3423 return FALSE;
3424 break;
3425 }
3426
3427 dodyn:
3428 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3429 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3430 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3431 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3432 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3433 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3434 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3435 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3436 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3437 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3438 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3439 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3440 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3441 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3442 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3443 symbol local.
3444
3445 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3446 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3447 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3448 symbol. */
3449 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3450 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3451 || (h != NULL
3452 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3453 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3454 || !h->def_regular))))
3455 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3456 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3457 && h != NULL
3458 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3459 || !h->def_regular)))
3460 {
3461 #ifdef DEBUG
3462 fprintf (stderr,
3463 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3464 "create relocation for %s\n",
3465 (h && h->root.root.string
3466 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3467 #endif
3468 if (sreloc == NULL)
3469 {
3470 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3471 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3472
3473 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3474 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3475
3476 if (sreloc == NULL)
3477 return FALSE;
3478 }
3479
3480 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3481 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3482 if (h != NULL)
3483 {
3484 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3485 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3486
3487 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3488 p = *rel_head;
3489 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3490 {
3491 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3492 if (p == NULL)
3493 return FALSE;
3494 p->next = *rel_head;
3495 *rel_head = p;
3496 p->sec = sec;
3497 p->count = 0;
3498 p->pc_count = 0;
3499 }
3500 p->count += 1;
3501 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3502 p->pc_count += 1;
3503 }
3504 else
3505 {
3506 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3507 We really need local syms available to do this
3508 easily. Oh well. */
3509 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3510 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3511 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3512 asection *s;
3513 void *vpp;
3514 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3515
3516 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3517 abfd, r_symndx);
3518 if (isym == NULL)
3519 return FALSE;
3520
3521 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3522 if (s == NULL)
3523 s = sec;
3524
3525 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3526 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3527 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3528 p = *rel_head;
3529 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3530 p = p->next;
3531 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3532 {
3533 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3534 if (p == NULL)
3535 return FALSE;
3536 p->next = *rel_head;
3537 *rel_head = p;
3538 p->sec = sec;
3539 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3540 p->count = 0;
3541 }
3542 p->count += 1;
3543 }
3544 }
3545
3546 break;
3547 }
3548 }
3549
3550 return TRUE;
3551 }
3552 \f
3553 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3554 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3555 bfd_boolean
3556 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3557 {
3558 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3559 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3560 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3561 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3562
3563 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3564 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3565
3566 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3567 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3568
3569 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3570 {
3571 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3572 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3573 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3574
3575 if (in_fp == 0)
3576 ;
3577 else if (out_fp == 0)
3578 {
3579 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3580 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3581 last_fp = ibfd;
3582 }
3583 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3584 {
3585 _bfd_error_handler
3586 /* xgettext:c-format */
3587 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3588 last_fp, ibfd);
3589 ret = FALSE;
3590 }
3591 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3592 {
3593 _bfd_error_handler
3594 /* xgettext:c-format */
3595 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3596 ibfd, last_fp);
3597 ret = FALSE;
3598 }
3599 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3600 {
3601 _bfd_error_handler
3602 /* xgettext:c-format */
3603 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3604 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3605 ret = FALSE;
3606 }
3607 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3608 {
3609 _bfd_error_handler
3610 /* xgettext:c-format */
3611 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3612 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3613 ret = FALSE;
3614 }
3615
3616 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3617 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3618 if (in_fp == 0)
3619 ;
3620 else if (out_fp == 0)
3621 {
3622 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3623 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3624 last_ld = ibfd;
3625 }
3626 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3627 {
3628 _bfd_error_handler
3629 /* xgettext:c-format */
3630 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3631 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3632 ret = FALSE;
3633 }
3634 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3635 {
3636 _bfd_error_handler
3637 /* xgettext:c-format */
3638 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3639 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3640 ret = FALSE;
3641 }
3642 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3643 {
3644 _bfd_error_handler
3645 /* xgettext:c-format */
3646 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3647 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3648 ret = FALSE;
3649 }
3650 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3651 {
3652 _bfd_error_handler
3653 /* xgettext:c-format */
3654 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3655 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3656 ret = FALSE;
3657 }
3658 }
3659
3660 if (!ret)
3661 {
3662 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3663 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3664 }
3665 return ret;
3666 }
3667
3668 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3669 there are conflicting attributes. */
3670 static bfd_boolean
3671 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3672 {
3673 bfd *obfd;
3674 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3675 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3676 bfd_boolean ret;
3677
3678 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3679 return FALSE;
3680
3681 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3682 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3683 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3684
3685 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3686 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3687 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3688 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3689 ret = TRUE;
3690 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3691 {
3692 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3693 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3694 static bfd *last_vec;
3695
3696 if (in_vec == 0)
3697 ;
3698 else if (out_vec == 0)
3699 {
3700 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3701 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3702 last_vec = ibfd;
3703 }
3704 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3705 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3706 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3707 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3708 case too. */
3709 else if (in_vec == 1)
3710 ;
3711 else if (out_vec == 1)
3712 {
3713 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3714 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3715 last_vec = ibfd;
3716 }
3717 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3718 {
3719 _bfd_error_handler
3720 /* xgettext:c-format */
3721 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3722 last_vec, ibfd);
3723 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3724 ret = FALSE;
3725 }
3726 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3727 {
3728 _bfd_error_handler
3729 /* xgettext:c-format */
3730 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3731 ibfd, last_vec);
3732 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3733 ret = FALSE;
3734 }
3735 }
3736
3737 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3738 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3739 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3740 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3741 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3742 {
3743 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3744 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3745 static bfd *last_struct;
3746
3747 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3748 ;
3749 else if (out_struct == 0)
3750 {
3751 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3752 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3753 last_struct = ibfd;
3754 }
3755 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3756 {
3757 _bfd_error_handler
3758 /* xgettext:c-format */
3759 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3760 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3761 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3762 ret = FALSE;
3763 }
3764 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3765 {
3766 _bfd_error_handler
3767 /* xgettext:c-format */
3768 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3769 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3770 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3771 ret = FALSE;
3772 }
3773 }
3774 if (!ret)
3775 {
3776 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3777 return FALSE;
3778 }
3779
3780 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3781 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3782 }
3783
3784 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3785 object file when linking. */
3786
3787 static bfd_boolean
3788 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3789 {
3790 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3791 flagword old_flags;
3792 flagword new_flags;
3793 bfd_boolean error;
3794
3795 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3796 return TRUE;
3797
3798 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3799 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3800 return FALSE;
3801
3802 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3803 return FALSE;
3804
3805 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3806 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3807 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3808 {
3809 /* First call, no flags set. */
3810 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3811 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3812 }
3813
3814 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3815 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3816 ;
3817
3818 /* Incompatible flags. */
3819 else
3820 {
3821 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3822 to be linked with either. */
3823 error = FALSE;
3824 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3825 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3826 {
3827 error = TRUE;
3828 _bfd_error_handler
3829 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3830 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3831 }
3832 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3833 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3834 {
3835 error = TRUE;
3836 _bfd_error_handler
3837 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3838 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3839 }
3840
3841 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3842 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3843 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3844
3845 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3846 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3847 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3848 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3849 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3850 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3851
3852 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3853 any module uses it. */
3854 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3855
3856 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3857 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3858
3859 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3860 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3861 {
3862 error = TRUE;
3863 _bfd_error_handler
3864 /* xgettext:c-format */
3865 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3866 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3867 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3868 }
3869
3870 if (error)
3871 {
3872 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3873 return FALSE;
3874 }
3875 }
3876
3877 return TRUE;
3878 }
3879
3880 static void
3881 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3882 asection *input_section,
3883 unsigned long offset,
3884 bfd_byte *loc,
3885 bfd_vma value,
3886 split16_format_type split16_format,
3887 bfd_boolean fixup)
3888 {
3889 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3890
3891 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3892 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3893 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3894 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3895 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3896 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3897 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3898 {
3899 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3900 {
3901 if (fixup)
3902 split16_format = split16a_type;
3903 else
3904 _bfd_error_handler
3905 /* xgettext:c-format */
3906 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3907 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3908 }
3909 }
3910 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3911 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3912 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3913 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3914 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3915 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3916 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3917 {
3918 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3919 {
3920 if (fixup)
3921 split16_format = split16d_type;
3922 else
3923 _bfd_error_handler
3924 /* xgettext:c-format */
3925 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3926 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3927 }
3928 }
3929 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3930 {
3931 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3932 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3933 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3934 {
3935 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3936 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3937 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3938 }
3939 }
3940 else
3941 {
3942 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3943 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3944 }
3945 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3946 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3947 }
3948
3949 static void
3950 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3951 {
3952 unsigned int insn;
3953
3954 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3955 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3956 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3957 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3958 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3959 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3960 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3961 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3962 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3963 }
3964
3965 \f
3966 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3967 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3968 int
3969 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3970 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3971 {
3972 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3973 flagword flags;
3974
3975 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3976
3977 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3978 {
3979 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3980
3981 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3982 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3983 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3984 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3985 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3986 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3987 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3988 || h->needs_plt)
3989 && h->ref_regular
3990 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3991 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3992 {
3993 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3994 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3995 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3996 r30 to be set up. */
3997 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3998 }
3999 else
4000 {
4001 bfd *ibfd;
4002 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4003
4004 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4005 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4006 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4007 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4008 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4009 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4010 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4011 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4012 {
4013 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4014 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4015 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4016 {
4017 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4018 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4019 break;
4020 }
4021 }
4022 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4023 }
4024 }
4025 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4026 {
4027 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4028 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4029 else
4030 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4031 }
4032
4033 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4034
4035 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4036 {
4037 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4038 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4039
4040 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4041 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4042 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.splt, flags))
4043 return -1;
4044
4045 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4046 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4047 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4048 return -1;
4049 }
4050 else
4051 {
4052 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4053 if (htab->glink != NULL
4054 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink, 0))
4055 return -1;
4056 }
4057 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4058 }
4059 \f
4060 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4061 relocation. */
4062
4063 static asection *
4064 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4065 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4066 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4067 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4068 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4069 {
4070 if (h != NULL)
4071 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4072 {
4073 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4074 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4075 return NULL;
4076 }
4077
4078 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4079 }
4080
4081 static bfd_boolean
4082 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4083 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4084 asection **symsecp,
4085 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4086 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4087 unsigned long r_symndx,
4088 bfd *ibfd)
4089 {
4090 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4091
4092 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4093 {
4094 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4095 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4096
4097 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4098 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4099 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4100 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4101
4102 if (hp != NULL)
4103 *hp = h;
4104
4105 if (symp != NULL)
4106 *symp = NULL;
4107
4108 if (symsecp != NULL)
4109 {
4110 asection *symsec = NULL;
4111 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4112 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4113 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4114 *symsecp = symsec;
4115 }
4116
4117 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4118 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4119 }
4120 else
4121 {
4122 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4123 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4124
4125 if (locsyms == NULL)
4126 {
4127 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4128 if (locsyms == NULL)
4129 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4130 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4131 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4132 if (locsyms == NULL)
4133 return FALSE;
4134 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4135 }
4136 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4137
4138 if (hp != NULL)
4139 *hp = NULL;
4140
4141 if (symp != NULL)
4142 *symp = sym;
4143
4144 if (symsecp != NULL)
4145 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4146
4147 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4148 {
4149 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4150 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4151
4152 tls_mask = NULL;
4153 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4154 if (local_got != NULL)
4155 {
4156 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4157 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4158 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4159 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4160 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4161 }
4162 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4163 }
4164 }
4165 return TRUE;
4166 }
4167 \f
4168 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4169 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4170
4171 bfd_boolean
4172 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4173 {
4174 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4175 bfd *ibfd;
4176 asection *sec;
4177 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4178
4179 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4180 if (htab == NULL)
4181 return FALSE;
4182
4183 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4184 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4185 between the call and its destination. */
4186 limit = 0x1e00000;
4187 low_vma = -1;
4188 high_vma = 0;
4189 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4190 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4191 {
4192 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4193 low_vma = sec->vma;
4194 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4195 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4196 }
4197
4198 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4199 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4200 is local. */
4201 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4202 {
4203 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4204 return TRUE;
4205 }
4206
4207 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4208 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4209 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4210 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4211 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4212 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4213 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4214 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4215 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4216 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4217 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4218 together except their symbol. */
4219
4220 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4221 {
4222 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4223 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4224
4225 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4226 continue;
4227
4228 local_syms = NULL;
4229 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4230
4231 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4232 if (sec->has_pltcall
4233 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4234 {
4235 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4236
4237 /* Read the relocations. */
4238 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4239 info->keep_memory);
4240 if (relstart == NULL)
4241 return FALSE;
4242
4243 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4244 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4245 {
4246 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4247 unsigned long r_symndx;
4248 asection *sym_sec;
4249 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4250 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4251 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4252
4253 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4254 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4255 continue;
4256
4257 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4258 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4259 r_symndx, ibfd))
4260 {
4261 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4262 free (relstart);
4263 if (local_syms != NULL
4264 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4265 free (local_syms);
4266 return FALSE;
4267 }
4268
4269 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4270 {
4271 bfd_vma from, to;
4272 if (h != NULL)
4273 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4274 else
4275 to = sym->st_value;
4276 to += (rel->r_addend
4277 + sym_sec->output_offset
4278 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4279 from = (rel->r_offset
4280 + sec->output_offset
4281 + sec->output_section->vma);
4282 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4283 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4284 }
4285 }
4286 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4287 free (relstart);
4288 }
4289
4290 if (local_syms != NULL
4291 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4292 {
4293 if (!info->keep_memory)
4294 free (local_syms);
4295 else
4296 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4297 }
4298 }
4299
4300 return TRUE;
4301 }
4302
4303 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4304 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4305
4306 asection *
4307 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4308 {
4309 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4310
4311 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4312 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4313 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4314 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4315 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4316
4317 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4318 {
4319 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4320 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4321 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4322 if (opt != NULL
4323 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4324 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4325 {
4326 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4327 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4328 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4329 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4330 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4331 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4332 && tga != NULL
4333 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4334 || tga->needs_plt)
4335 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4336 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4337 {
4338 struct plt_entry *ent;
4339 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4340 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4341 break;
4342 if (ent != NULL)
4343 {
4344 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4345 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4346 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4347 opt->mark = 1;
4348 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4349 {
4350 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4351 opt->dynindx = -1;
4352 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4353 opt->dynstr_index);
4354 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4355 return FALSE;
4356 }
4357 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4358 }
4359 }
4360 }
4361 else
4362 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4363 }
4364 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4365 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4366 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4367 {
4368 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4369 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4370 }
4371
4372 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4373 }
4374
4375 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4376 HASH. */
4377
4378 static bfd_boolean
4379 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4380 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4381 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4382 {
4383 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4384 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4385 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4386
4387 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4388 {
4389 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4390 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4391
4392 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4393 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4394 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4395 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4396 if (h == hash)
4397 return TRUE;
4398 }
4399 return FALSE;
4400 }
4401
4402 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4403 opportunities. */
4404
4405 bfd_boolean
4406 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4407 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4408 {
4409 bfd *ibfd;
4410 asection *sec;
4411 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4412 int pass;
4413
4414 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4415 return TRUE;
4416
4417 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4418 if (htab == NULL)
4419 return FALSE;
4420
4421 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4422 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4423 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4424 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4425 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4426 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4427 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4428 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4429 {
4430 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4431 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4432
4433 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4434 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4435 {
4436 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4437 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4438
4439 /* Read the relocations. */
4440 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4441 info->keep_memory);
4442 if (relstart == NULL)
4443 return FALSE;
4444
4445 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4446 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4447 {
4448 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4449 unsigned long r_symndx;
4450 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4451 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4452 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4453 bfd_boolean is_local;
4454 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4455
4456 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4457 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4458 {
4459 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4460
4461 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4462 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4463 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4464 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4465 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4466 }
4467
4468 is_local = FALSE;
4469 if (h == NULL
4470 || !h->def_dynamic)
4471 is_local = TRUE;
4472
4473 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4474 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4475 without marker relocs, then check that each
4476 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4477 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4478 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4479 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4480 if (pass == 0
4481 && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4482 && h != NULL
4483 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4484 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4485 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4486 {
4487 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4488 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4489 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4490 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4491 free (relstart);
4492 return TRUE;
4493 }
4494
4495 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4496 switch (r_type)
4497 {
4498 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4499 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4500 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4501 /* Fall through. */
4502
4503 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4504 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4505 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4506 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4507 that turns out to be the case. */
4508 if (!is_local)
4509 continue;
4510
4511 /* LD -> LE */
4512 tls_set = 0;
4513 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4514 break;
4515
4516 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4517 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4518 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4519 /* Fall through. */
4520
4521 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4522 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4523 if (is_local)
4524 /* GD -> LE */
4525 tls_set = 0;
4526 else
4527 /* GD -> IE */
4528 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPRELGD;
4529 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4530 break;
4531
4532 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4533 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4534 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4535 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4536 if (is_local)
4537 {
4538 /* IE -> LE */
4539 tls_set = 0;
4540 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4541 break;
4542 }
4543 else
4544 continue;
4545
4546 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4547 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4548 if (rel + 1 < relend
4549 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4550 {
4551 if (pass != 0
4552 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4553 {
4554 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4555 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4556 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4557 {
4558 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4559
4560 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4561 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4562 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4563 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4564 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4565 if (h != NULL)
4566 {
4567 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4568 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4569
4570 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4571 addend = rel->r_addend;
4572 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4573 got2, addend);
4574 if (ent != NULL
4575 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4576 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4577 }
4578 }
4579 }
4580 continue;
4581 }
4582 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4583 tls_set = 0;
4584 tls_clear = 0;
4585 break;
4586
4587 default:
4588 continue;
4589 }
4590
4591 if (pass == 0)
4592 {
4593 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4594 || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
4595 continue;
4596
4597 if (rel + 1 < relend
4598 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4599 htab->tls_get_addr))
4600 continue;
4601
4602 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4603 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4604 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4605 the entire optimization. */
4606 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4607 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4608 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4609 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4610 free (relstart);
4611 return TRUE;
4612 }
4613
4614 if (h != NULL)
4615 {
4616 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4617 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4618 }
4619 else
4620 {
4621 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4622 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4623 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4624
4625 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4626 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4627 abort ();
4628 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4629 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4630 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4631 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4632 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4633 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4634 }
4635
4636 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4637 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4638 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4639 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4640 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4641 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4642 Disable optimization in this case. */
4643 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4644 && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4645 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4646 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4647 continue;
4648
4649 if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
4650 {
4651 struct plt_entry *ent;
4652 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4653
4654 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4655 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4656 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4657 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4658 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4659 got2, addend);
4660 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4661 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4662
4663 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
4664 continue;
4665 }
4666
4667 if (tls_set == 0)
4668 {
4669 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4670 if (*got_count > 0)
4671 *got_count -= 1;
4672 }
4673
4674 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4675 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4676 }
4677
4678 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4679 free (relstart);
4680 }
4681 }
4682 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4683 return TRUE;
4684 }
4685 \f
4686 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4687
4688 static asection *
4689 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4690 {
4691 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4692
4693 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4694 {
4695 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4696
4697 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4698 return p->sec;
4699 }
4700 return NULL;
4701 }
4702
4703 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4704 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4705 size_dynamic_sections. */
4706
4707 static bfd_boolean
4708 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4709 {
4710 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4711 do
4712 {
4713 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4714 return TRUE;
4715 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4716 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4717
4718 return FALSE;
4719 }
4720
4721 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4722
4723 static bfd_boolean
4724 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4725 {
4726 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4727
4728 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4729 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4730 return TRUE;
4731 return FALSE;
4732 }
4733
4734 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4735 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4736 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4737 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4738 understand. */
4739
4740 static bfd_boolean
4741 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4742 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4743 {
4744 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4745 asection *s;
4746
4747 #ifdef DEBUG
4748 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4749 h->root.root.string);
4750 #endif
4751
4752 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4753 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4754 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4755 && (h->needs_plt
4756 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4757 || h->is_weakalias
4758 || (h->def_dynamic
4759 && h->ref_regular
4760 && !h->def_regular)));
4761
4762 /* Deal with function syms. */
4763 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4764 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4765 || h->needs_plt)
4766 {
4767 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4768 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4769 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4770 function symbol is local. */
4771 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4772 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4773
4774 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4775 won't need a .plt entry. */
4776 struct plt_entry *ent;
4777 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4778 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4779 break;
4780 if (ent == NULL
4781 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4782 && local
4783 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4784 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4785 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4786 {
4787 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4788
4789 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4790 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4791 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4792
4793 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4794
4795 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4796 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4797 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4798 h->needs_plt = 0;
4799 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4800 }
4801 else
4802 {
4803 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4804 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4805 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4806 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4807 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4808 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4809 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4810 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4811 than link time. */
4812 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4813 || (h->non_got_ref
4814 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4815 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4816 && !htab->is_vxworks
4817 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4818 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4819 {
4820 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4821 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4822 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4823 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4824 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4825 }
4826 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4827 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4828 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4829 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4830 }
4831 h->protected_def = 0;
4832 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4833 return TRUE;
4834 }
4835 else
4836 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4837
4838 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4839 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4840 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4841 if (h->is_weakalias)
4842 {
4843 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4844 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4845 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4846 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4847 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4848 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4849 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4850 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4851 return TRUE;
4852 }
4853
4854 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4855 is not a function. */
4856
4857 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4858 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4859 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4860 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4861 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4862 {
4863 h->protected_def = 0;
4864 return TRUE;
4865 }
4866
4867 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4868 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4869 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4870 {
4871 h->protected_def = 0;
4872 return TRUE;
4873 }
4874
4875 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4876 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4877 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4878 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4879 if (h->protected_def)
4880 {
4881 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4882 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4883 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4884 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4885 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4886 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4887 return TRUE;
4888 }
4889
4890 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4891 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4892 return TRUE;
4893
4894 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4895 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4896 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4897 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4898 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4899 executable. */
4900 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4901 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4902 && !htab->is_vxworks
4903 && !h->def_regular
4904 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4905 return TRUE;
4906
4907 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4908 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4909 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4910 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4911 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4912 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4913 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4914 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4915 same memory location for the variable.
4916
4917 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4918 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4919 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4920 s = htab->dynsbss;
4921 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4922 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4923 else
4924 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4925 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4926
4927 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4928 {
4929 asection *srel;
4930
4931 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4932 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4933 and into the runtime process image. */
4934 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4935 srel = htab->relsbss;
4936 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4937 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4938 else
4939 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4940 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4941 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4942 h->needs_copy = 1;
4943 }
4944
4945 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4946 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4947 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4948 }
4949 \f
4950 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4951 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4952 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4953 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4954 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4955
4956 static bfd_boolean
4957 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4958 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4959 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4960 {
4961 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4962 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4963 char *name;
4964 const char *stub;
4965 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4966
4967 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4968 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4969 else
4970 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4971
4972 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4973 len2 = strlen (stub);
4974 len3 = 0;
4975 if (ent->sec)
4976 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4977 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4978 if (name == NULL)
4979 return FALSE;
4980 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4981 if (ent->sec)
4982 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4983 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4984 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4985 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4986 if (sh == NULL)
4987 return FALSE;
4988 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4989 {
4990 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4991 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4992 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4993 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4994 sh->def_regular = 1;
4995 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4996 sh->forced_local = 1;
4997 sh->non_elf = 0;
4998 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4999 }
5000 return TRUE;
5001 }
5002
5003 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5004 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5005
5006 static bfd_vma
5007 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5008 {
5009 bfd_vma where;
5010 unsigned int max_before_header;
5011
5012 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5013 {
5014 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5015 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5016 }
5017 else
5018 {
5019 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5020 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5021 {
5022 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5023 htab->got_gap -= need;
5024 }
5025 else
5026 {
5027 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5028 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5029 {
5030 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5031 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5032 }
5033 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5034 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5035 }
5036 }
5037 return where;
5038 }
5039
5040 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5041 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5042
5043 static inline unsigned int
5044 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5045 {
5046 unsigned int need;
5047 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5048 need = 4;
5049 else
5050 {
5051 need = 0;
5052 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5053 need += 8;
5054 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
5055 need += 4;
5056 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5057 need += 4;
5058 }
5059 return need;
5060 }
5061
5062 /* Calculate size of relocs needed for symbol given its TLS_MASK and
5063 NEEDed GOT entries. KNOWN says a TPREL offset can be calculated at
5064 link time. */
5065
5066 static inline unsigned int
5067 got_relocs_needed (int tls_mask, unsigned int need, bfd_boolean known)
5068 {
5069 /* All the entries we allocated need relocs.
5070 Except IE in executable with a local symbol. We could also omit
5071 the DTPREL reloc on the second word of a GD entry under the same
5072 condition as that for IE, but ld.so needs to differentiate
5073 LD and GD entries. */
5074 if (known && (tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5075 && (tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
5076 need -= 4;
5077 return need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5078 }
5079
5080 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5081
5082 static bfd_boolean
5083 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5084 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5085 {
5086 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5087
5088 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5089 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5090 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5091 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5092 && h->dynindx == -1
5093 && !h->forced_local
5094 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5095 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5096 return TRUE;
5097 }
5098
5099 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5100
5101 static bfd_boolean
5102 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5103 {
5104 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5105 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5106 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5107 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5108 bfd_boolean dyn;
5109
5110 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5111 return TRUE;
5112
5113 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5114 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5115 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5116 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5117 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5118 && eh->elf.protected_def
5119 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5120 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5121 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5122 {
5123 unsigned int need;
5124
5125 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5126 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5127 return FALSE;
5128
5129 need = 0;
5130 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5131 {
5132 if (!eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5133 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5134 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5135 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5136 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5137 else
5138 need += 8;
5139 }
5140 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5141 if (need == 0)
5142 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5143 else
5144 {
5145 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5146 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
5147 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5148 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5149 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5150 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5151 {
5152 asection *rsec;
5153 bfd_boolean tprel_known = (bfd_link_executable (info)
5154 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info,
5155 &eh->elf));
5156
5157 need = got_relocs_needed (eh->tls_mask, need, tprel_known);
5158 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
5159 && eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5160 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5161 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5162 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5163 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5164 rsec->size += need;
5165 }
5166 }
5167 }
5168 else
5169 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5170
5171 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5172 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5173 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5174 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5175 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5176
5177 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5178 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5179 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5180 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5181
5182 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5183 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5184 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5185 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5186
5187 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5188 ;
5189
5190 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5191 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5192 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5193 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5194 changes. */
5195 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5196 {
5197 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5198 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5199 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5200 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5201 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5202 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5203 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5204 {
5205 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5206
5207 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5208 {
5209 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5210 p->pc_count = 0;
5211 if (p->count == 0)
5212 *pp = p->next;
5213 else
5214 pp = &p->next;
5215 }
5216 }
5217
5218 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5219 {
5220 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5221
5222 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5223 {
5224 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5225 *pp = p->next;
5226 else
5227 pp = &p->next;
5228 }
5229 }
5230
5231 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5232 {
5233 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5234 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5235 return FALSE;
5236 }
5237 }
5238 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5239 {
5240 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5241 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5242 dynamic. */
5243 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5244 && !h->def_regular
5245 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5246 && !(h->protected_def
5247 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5248 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5249 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5250 {
5251 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5252 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5253 return FALSE;
5254
5255 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5256 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5257 }
5258 else
5259 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5260 }
5261
5262 /* Allocate space. */
5263 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5264 {
5265 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5266 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5267 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5268 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5269 }
5270
5271 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5272 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5273 a) is dynamic, or
5274 b) is an ifunc, or
5275 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5276 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5277 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5278 if (dyn
5279 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5280 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5281 || (h->needs_plt
5282 && h->def_regular
5283 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5284 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5285 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5286 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5287 {
5288 struct plt_entry *ent;
5289 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5290 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5291
5292 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5293 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5294 {
5295 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5296
5297 if (!dyn)
5298 {
5299 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5300 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5301 else
5302 s = htab->pltlocal;
5303 }
5304
5305 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5306 {
5307 if (!doneone)
5308 {
5309 plt_offset = s->size;
5310 s->size += 4;
5311 }
5312 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5313
5314 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5315 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5316 else
5317 {
5318 s = htab->glink;
5319 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5320 {
5321 glink_offset = s->size;
5322 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5323 }
5324 if (!doneone
5325 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5326 && h->def_dynamic
5327 && !h->def_regular)
5328 {
5329 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5330 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5331 }
5332 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5333
5334 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5335 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5336 return FALSE;
5337 }
5338 }
5339 else
5340 {
5341 if (!doneone)
5342 {
5343 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5344 for the special first entry. */
5345 if (s->size == 0)
5346 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5347
5348 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5349 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5350 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5351 word available at the end. */
5352 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5353 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5354 * ((s->size
5355 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5356 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5357
5358 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5359 file, and we are not generating a shared
5360 library, then set the symbol to this location
5361 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5362 relocations, and is required to make
5363 function pointers compare as equal between
5364 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5365 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5366 && h->def_dynamic
5367 && !h->def_regular)
5368 {
5369 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5370 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5371 }
5372
5373 /* Make room for this entry. */
5374 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5375 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5376 is allocated. */
5377 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5378 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5379 / htab->plt_entry_size
5380 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5381 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5382 }
5383 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5384 }
5385
5386 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5387 if (!doneone)
5388 {
5389 if (!dyn)
5390 {
5391 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5392 {
5393 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5394 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5395 }
5396 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5397 {
5398 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5399 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5400 }
5401 }
5402 else
5403 {
5404 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5405
5406 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5407 {
5408 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5409 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5410 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5411 {
5412 if (ent->plt.offset
5413 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5414 {
5415 htab->srelplt2->size
5416 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5417 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5418 }
5419
5420 htab->srelplt2->size
5421 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5422 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5423 }
5424
5425 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5426 .got.plt. */
5427 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5428 }
5429 }
5430 doneone = TRUE;
5431 }
5432 }
5433 else
5434 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5435
5436 if (!doneone)
5437 {
5438 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5439 h->needs_plt = 0;
5440 }
5441 }
5442 else
5443 {
5444 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5445 h->needs_plt = 0;
5446 }
5447
5448 return TRUE;
5449 }
5450
5451 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5452 read-only sections. */
5453
5454 static bfd_boolean
5455 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5456 {
5457 asection *sec;
5458
5459 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5460 return TRUE;
5461
5462 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5463 if (sec != NULL)
5464 {
5465 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5466
5467 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5468 info->callbacks->minfo
5469 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5470 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5471
5472 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5473 return FALSE;
5474 }
5475 return TRUE;
5476 }
5477
5478 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5479 {
5480 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5481 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5482 1, /* CIE version. */
5483 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5484 4, /* Code alignment. */
5485 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5486 65, /* RA reg. */
5487 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5488 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5489 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5490 };
5491
5492 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5493
5494 static bfd_boolean
5495 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5496 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5497 {
5498 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5499 asection *s;
5500 bfd_boolean relocs;
5501 bfd *ibfd;
5502
5503 #ifdef DEBUG
5504 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5505 #endif
5506
5507 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5508 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5509
5510 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5511 {
5512 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5513 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5514 {
5515 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5516 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5517 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5518 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5519 }
5520 }
5521
5522 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5523 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5524 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5525 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5526
5527 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5528 relocs. */
5529 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5530 {
5531 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5532 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5533 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5534 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5535 char *lgot_masks;
5536 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5537 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5538
5539 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5540 continue;
5541
5542 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5543 {
5544 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5545
5546 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5547 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5548 p != NULL;
5549 p = p->next)
5550 {
5551 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5552 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5553 {
5554 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5555 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5556 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5557 the relocs too. */
5558 }
5559 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5560 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5561 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5562 {
5563 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5564 handled specially by the loader. */
5565 }
5566 else if (p->count != 0)
5567 {
5568 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5569 if (p->ifunc)
5570 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5571 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5572 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5573 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5574 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5575 {
5576 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5577 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5578 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5579 }
5580 }
5581 }
5582 }
5583
5584 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5585 if (!local_got)
5586 continue;
5587
5588 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5589 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5590 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5591 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5592 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5593 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5594
5595 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5596 if (*local_got > 0)
5597 {
5598 unsigned int need;
5599 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5600 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5601 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5602 if (need == 0)
5603 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5604 else
5605 {
5606 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5607 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5608 {
5609 asection *srel;
5610 bfd_boolean tprel_known = bfd_link_executable (info);
5611
5612 need = got_relocs_needed (*lgot_masks, need, tprel_known);
5613 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5614 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5615 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5616 srel->size += need;
5617 }
5618 }
5619 }
5620 else
5621 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5622
5623 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5624 continue;
5625
5626 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5627 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5628 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5629 {
5630 struct plt_entry *ent;
5631 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5632 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5633
5634 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5635 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5636 {
5637 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5638 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5639 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5640 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5641 {
5642 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5643 continue;
5644 }
5645 else
5646 s = htab->pltlocal;
5647
5648 if (!doneone)
5649 {
5650 plt_offset = s->size;
5651 s->size += 4;
5652 }
5653 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5654
5655 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5656 {
5657 s = htab->glink;
5658 glink_offset = s->size;
5659 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5660 }
5661 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5662
5663 if (!doneone)
5664 {
5665 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5666 {
5667 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5668 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5669 }
5670 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5671 {
5672 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5673 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5674 }
5675 doneone = TRUE;
5676 }
5677 }
5678 else
5679 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5680 }
5681 }
5682
5683 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5684 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5685
5686 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5687 {
5688 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5689 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5690 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5691 }
5692 else
5693 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5694
5695 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5696 {
5697 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5698
5699 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5700 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5701 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5702 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5703 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5704 {
5705 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5706 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5707 g_o_t += 4;
5708 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5709 }
5710
5711 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5712 }
5713 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5714 {
5715 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5716
5717 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5718 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5719 }
5720 if (info->emitrelocations)
5721 {
5722 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5723
5724 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5725 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5726 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5727 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5728 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5729 }
5730
5731 if (htab->glink != NULL
5732 && htab->glink->size != 0
5733 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5734 {
5735 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5736 /* Space for the branch table. */
5737 htab->glink->size
5738 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5739 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5740 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5741 ? 63 : 15);
5742 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5743
5744 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5745 {
5746 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5747 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5748 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5749 if (sh == NULL)
5750 return FALSE;
5751 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5752 {
5753 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5754 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5755 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5756 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5757 sh->def_regular = 1;
5758 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5759 sh->forced_local = 1;
5760 sh->non_elf = 0;
5761 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5762 }
5763 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5764 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5765 if (sh == NULL)
5766 return FALSE;
5767 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5768 {
5769 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5770 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5771 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5772 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5773 sh->def_regular = 1;
5774 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5775 sh->forced_local = 1;
5776 sh->non_elf = 0;
5777 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5778 }
5779 }
5780 }
5781
5782 if (htab->glink != NULL
5783 && htab->glink->size != 0
5784 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5785 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5786 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5787 {
5788 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5789 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5790 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5791 {
5792 s->size += 4;
5793 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5794 s->size += 4;
5795 }
5796 }
5797
5798 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5799 Allocate memory for them. */
5800 relocs = FALSE;
5801 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5802 {
5803 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5804
5805 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5806 continue;
5807
5808 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5809 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5810 {
5811 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5812 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5813 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5814 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5815 strip_section = FALSE;
5816 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5817 comment below. */
5818 }
5819 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5820 || s == htab->pltlocal
5821 || s == htab->glink
5822 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5823 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5824 || s == htab->sbss
5825 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5826 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5827 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5828 {
5829 /* Strip these too. */
5830 }
5831 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5832 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5833 {
5834 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5835 }
5836 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_get_section_name (htab->elf.dynobj, s),
5837 ".rela"))
5838 {
5839 if (s->size != 0)
5840 {
5841 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5842 relocs = TRUE;
5843
5844 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5845 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5846 s->reloc_count = 0;
5847 }
5848 }
5849 else
5850 {
5851 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5852 continue;
5853 }
5854
5855 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5856 {
5857 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5858 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5859 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5860 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5861 before the linker maps input sections to output
5862 sections. The linker does that before
5863 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5864 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5865 into these sections. */
5866 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5867 continue;
5868 }
5869
5870 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5871 continue;
5872
5873 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5874 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5875 if (s->contents == NULL)
5876 return FALSE;
5877 }
5878
5879 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5880 {
5881 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5882 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5883 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5884 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5885 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5886 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5887 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5888
5889 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5890 {
5891 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5892 return FALSE;
5893 }
5894
5895 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5896 {
5897 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5898 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5899 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5900 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5901 return FALSE;
5902 }
5903
5904 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5905 && htab->glink != NULL
5906 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5907 {
5908 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5909 return FALSE;
5910 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5911 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5912 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5913 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5914 return FALSE;
5915 }
5916
5917 if (relocs)
5918 {
5919 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5920 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5921 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5922 return FALSE;
5923 }
5924
5925 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5926 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5927 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5928 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5929 info);
5930
5931 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5932 {
5933 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5934 return FALSE;
5935 }
5936 if (htab->is_vxworks
5937 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5938 return FALSE;
5939 }
5940 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5941
5942 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5943 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5944 {
5945 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5946 bfd_vma val;
5947
5948 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5949 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5950 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5951 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5952 /* FDE length. */
5953 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5954 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5955 p += 4;
5956 /* CIE pointer. */
5957 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5958 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5959 p += 4;
5960 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5961 p += 4;
5962 /* .glink size. */
5963 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5964 p += 4;
5965 /* Augmentation. */
5966 p += 1;
5967
5968 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5969 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5970 {
5971 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5972 if (adv < 64)
5973 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5974 else if (adv < 256)
5975 {
5976 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5977 *p++ = adv;
5978 }
5979 else if (adv < 65536)
5980 {
5981 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5982 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5983 p += 2;
5984 }
5985 else
5986 {
5987 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5988 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5989 p += 4;
5990 }
5991 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5992 *p++ = 65;
5993 p++;
5994 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5995 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5996 *p++ = 65;
5997 }
5998 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5999 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
6000 }
6001
6002 return TRUE;
6003 }
6004
6005 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
6006 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
6007
6008 static void
6009 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
6010 {
6011 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
6012
6013 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6014 {
6015 asection *s;
6016
6017 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6018 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6019 {
6020 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6021 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6022 {
6023 sda->def_regular = 0;
6024 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6025 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6026 sda->forced_local = 0;
6027 }
6028 }
6029 }
6030 }
6031
6032 void
6033 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6034 {
6035 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6036
6037 if (htab != NULL)
6038 {
6039 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6040 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6041 }
6042 }
6043
6044
6045 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6046
6047 static bfd_boolean
6048 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6049 {
6050 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6051 && !h->def_regular
6052 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6053 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6054 return FALSE;
6055
6056 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6057 }
6058 \f
6059 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6060
6061 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6062 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6063 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6064 {
6065 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6066 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6067 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6068 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6069 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6070 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6071 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6072 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6073 };
6074
6075 static const int stub_entry[] =
6076 {
6077 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6078 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6079 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6080 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6081 };
6082
6083 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6084 {
6085 unsigned int workaround_size;
6086 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6087 };
6088
6089 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6090 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6091 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6092 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6093
6094 static bfd_boolean
6095 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6096 asection *isec,
6097 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6098 bfd_boolean *again)
6099 {
6100 struct one_branch_fixup
6101 {
6102 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6103 asection *tsec;
6104 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6105 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6106 bfd_vma toff;
6107 bfd_vma trampoff;
6108 };
6109
6110 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6111 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6112 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6113 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6114 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6115 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6116 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6117 unsigned changes = 0;
6118 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6119 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6120 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6121 asection *got2;
6122 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6123
6124 *again = FALSE;
6125
6126 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6127 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6128 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6129 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6130 || isec->size < 4)
6131 return TRUE;
6132
6133 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6134 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6135 anyway. */
6136 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6137 return TRUE;
6138
6139 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6140 if (htab == NULL)
6141 return TRUE;
6142
6143 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6144 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6145 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6146 trampbase = isec->size;
6147
6148 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6149 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6150 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6151
6152 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6153 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6154 {
6155 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6156 {
6157 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6158 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6159 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6160 return FALSE;
6161 }
6162 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6163 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6164 }
6165
6166 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6167 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6168 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6169 trampoff = trampbase;
6170 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6171 trampoff += 4;
6172
6173 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6174 picfixup_size = 0;
6175 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6176 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6177 {
6178 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6179 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6180 {
6181 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6182 link_info->keep_memory);
6183 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6184 goto error_return;
6185 }
6186
6187 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6188
6189 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6190 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6191 {
6192 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6193 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6194 asection *tsec;
6195 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6196 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6197 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6198 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6199 unsigned long t0;
6200 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6201 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6202 struct plt_entry **plist;
6203 unsigned char sym_type;
6204
6205 switch (r_type)
6206 {
6207 case R_PPC_REL24:
6208 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6209 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6210 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6211 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6212 break;
6213
6214 case R_PPC_REL14:
6215 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6216 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6217 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6218 break;
6219
6220 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6221 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6222 break;
6223 continue;
6224
6225 default:
6226 continue;
6227 }
6228
6229 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6230 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6231 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6232 goto error_return;
6233
6234 if (isym != NULL)
6235 {
6236 if (tsec != NULL)
6237 ;
6238 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6239 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6240 else
6241 continue;
6242
6243 toff = isym->st_value;
6244 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6245 }
6246 else
6247 {
6248 if (tsec != NULL)
6249 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6250 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6251 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6252 {
6253 unsigned long indx;
6254
6255 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6256 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6257 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6258 }
6259 else
6260 continue;
6261
6262 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6263 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6264 branch stub in that case. */
6265 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6266 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6267 && irel != internal_relocs)
6268 {
6269 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6270 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6271 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6272
6273 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6274 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6275 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6276 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6277 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6278 {
6279 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6280
6281 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6282 {
6283 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6284 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6285 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6286 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6287 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6288 }
6289 }
6290 else
6291 {
6292 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6293 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6294
6295 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6296 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6297 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6298
6299 tls_mask
6300 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6301 }
6302
6303 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6304 optimised away. */
6305 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6306 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6307 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6308 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6309 continue;
6310 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6311 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6312 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6313 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6314 continue;
6315 }
6316
6317 sym_type = h->type;
6318 }
6319
6320 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6321 {
6322 if (h != NULL
6323 && !h->def_regular
6324 && h->protected_def
6325 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6326 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6327 picfixup_size += 12;
6328 continue;
6329 }
6330
6331 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6332 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6333 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6334 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6335 plist = NULL;
6336 if (h != NULL)
6337 {
6338 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6339 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6340 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6341 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6342 }
6343 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6344 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6345 {
6346 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6347 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6348 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6349 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6350 }
6351 if (plist != NULL)
6352 {
6353 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6354 struct plt_entry *ent;
6355
6356 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6357 addend = irel->r_addend;
6358 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6359 if (ent != NULL)
6360 {
6361 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6362 || h == NULL
6363 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6364 || h->dynindx == -1)
6365 {
6366 tsec = htab->glink;
6367 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6368 }
6369 else
6370 {
6371 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6372 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6373 }
6374 }
6375 }
6376
6377 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6378 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6379 branch overflow. */
6380 if (tsec == isec)
6381 continue;
6382
6383 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6384 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6385 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6386 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6387 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6388 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6389 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6390 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6391 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6392 continue;
6393
6394 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6395 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6396 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6397 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6398 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6399 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6400 {
6401 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6402 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6403 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6404 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6405 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6406
6407 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6408 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6409 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6410 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6411 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6412 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6413 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6414 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6415 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6416 location of interest is just "sym". */
6417 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6418 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6419 toff += irel->r_addend;
6420
6421 toff
6422 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6423 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6424 toff);
6425
6426 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6427 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6428 toff += irel->r_addend;
6429 }
6430 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6431 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6432 toff += irel->r_addend;
6433
6434 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6435 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6436 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6437 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6438 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6439 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6440 continue;
6441
6442 roff = irel->r_offset;
6443
6444 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6445 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6446 fixup can be created at final link.
6447 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6448 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6449 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6450 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6451 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6452 continue;
6453
6454 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6455 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6456 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6457 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6458 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6459 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6460 {
6461 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6462
6463 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6464 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6465 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6466 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6467 continue;
6468 }
6469
6470 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6471 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6472 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6473 break;
6474
6475 if (f == NULL)
6476 {
6477 size_t size;
6478 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6479
6480 val = trampoff - roff;
6481 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6482 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6483 one. We'll report an error later. */
6484 continue;
6485
6486 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6487 {
6488 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6489 insn_offset = 12;
6490 }
6491 else
6492 {
6493 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6494 insn_offset = 0;
6495 }
6496 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6497 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6498 || tsec == htab->glink)
6499 {
6500 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6501 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6502 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6503 }
6504
6505 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6506 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6507 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6508 stub_rtype);
6509 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6510 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6511 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6512 irel->r_addend = 0;
6513
6514 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6515 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6516 f->next = branch_fixups;
6517 f->tsec = tsec;
6518 f->toff = toff;
6519 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6520 branch_fixups = f;
6521
6522 trampoff += size;
6523 changes++;
6524 }
6525 else
6526 {
6527 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6528 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6529 continue;
6530
6531 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6532 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6533 }
6534
6535 /* Get the section contents. */
6536 if (contents == NULL)
6537 {
6538 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6539 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6540 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6541 /* Go get them off disk. */
6542 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6543 goto error_return;
6544 }
6545
6546 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6547 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6548 switch (r_type)
6549 {
6550 case R_PPC_REL24:
6551 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6552 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6553 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6554 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6555 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6556 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6557 break;
6558
6559 case R_PPC_REL14:
6560 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6561 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6562 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6563 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6564 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6565 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6566 break;
6567 }
6568 }
6569
6570 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6571 {
6572 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6573 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6574 free (f);
6575 }
6576 }
6577
6578 workaround_change = FALSE;
6579 newsize = trampoff;
6580 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6581 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6582 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6583 {
6584 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6585 unsigned int crossings;
6586 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6587
6588 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6589 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6590 addr &= -pagesize;
6591 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6592 if (crossings != 0)
6593 {
6594 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6595 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6596 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6597 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6598 newsize += crossings * 16;
6599 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6600 {
6601 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6602 workaround_change = TRUE;
6603 }
6604 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6605 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6606 }
6607 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6608 }
6609
6610 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6611 {
6612 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6613 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6614 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6615 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6616 }
6617
6618 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6619 isec->size = newsize;
6620
6621 if (isymbuf != NULL
6622 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6623 {
6624 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6625 free (isymbuf);
6626 else
6627 {
6628 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6629 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6630 }
6631 }
6632
6633 if (contents != NULL
6634 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6635 {
6636 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6637 free (contents);
6638 else
6639 {
6640 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6641 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6642 }
6643 }
6644
6645 changes += picfixup_size;
6646 if (changes != 0)
6647 {
6648 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6649 information for the trampolines. */
6650 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6651 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6652 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6653 unsigned ix;
6654
6655 if (!new_relocs)
6656 goto error_return;
6657 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6658 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6659 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6660 {
6661 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6662
6663 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6664 }
6665 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6666 free (internal_relocs);
6667 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6668 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6669 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6670 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6671 }
6672 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6673 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6674 free (internal_relocs);
6675
6676 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6677 return TRUE;
6678
6679 error_return:
6680 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6681 {
6682 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6683 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6684 free (f);
6685 }
6686 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6687 free (isymbuf);
6688 if (contents != NULL
6689 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6690 free (contents);
6691 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6692 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6693 free (internal_relocs);
6694 return FALSE;
6695 }
6696 \f
6697 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6698 discarded sections. */
6699
6700 static unsigned int
6701 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6702 {
6703 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6704 return 0;
6705
6706 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6707 return 0;
6708
6709 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6710 }
6711 \f
6712 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6713
6714 static bfd_vma
6715 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6716 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6717 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6718 bfd_vma relocation,
6719 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6720 {
6721 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6722
6723 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6724
6725 if (h != NULL)
6726 {
6727 /* Handle global symbol. */
6728 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6729
6730 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6731 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6732 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6733 }
6734 else
6735 {
6736 /* Handle local symbol. */
6737 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6738
6739 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6740 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6741 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6742 }
6743
6744 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6745 rel->r_addend,
6746 lsect);
6747 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6748
6749 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6750 as a "written" flag. */
6751 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6752 {
6753 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6754 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6755 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6756 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6757 }
6758
6759 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6760 + lsect->section->output_offset
6761 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6762 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6763
6764 #ifdef DEBUG
6765 fprintf (stderr,
6766 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6767 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6768 #endif
6769
6770 return relocation;
6771 }
6772
6773 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6774 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6775 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6776
6777 static void
6778 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6779 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6780 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6781 {
6782 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6783 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6784 bfd_vma plt;
6785 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6786
6787 if (h != NULL
6788 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6789 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6790 {
6791 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6792 p += 4;
6793 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6794 p += 4;
6795 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6796 p += 4;
6797 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6798 p += 4;
6799 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6800 p += 4;
6801 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6802 p += 4;
6803 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6804 p += 4;
6805 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6806 p += 4;
6807 }
6808
6809 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6810 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6811 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6812
6813 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6814 {
6815 bfd_vma got = 0;
6816
6817 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6818 got = (ent->addend
6819 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6820 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6821 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6822 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6823
6824 plt -= got;
6825
6826 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6827 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6828 else
6829 {
6830 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6831 p += 4;
6832 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6833 }
6834 }
6835 else
6836 {
6837 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6838 p += 4;
6839 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6840 }
6841 p += 4;
6842 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6843 p += 4;
6844 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6845 p += 4;
6846 while (p < end)
6847 {
6848 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6849 p += 4;
6850 }
6851 }
6852
6853 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6854
6855 static bfd_boolean
6856 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6857 {
6858 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6859 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6860 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6861 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6862 }
6863
6864 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6865 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6866 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6867
6868 unsigned int
6869 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6870 {
6871 unsigned int rtra;
6872
6873 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6874 return 0;
6875
6876 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6877 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6878 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6879 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6880 else
6881 return 0;
6882
6883 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6884 /* add -> addi. */
6885 insn = 14 << 26;
6886 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6887 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6888 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6889 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6890 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6891 insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6892 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6893 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6894 insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6895 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6896 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6897 insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6898 else
6899 return 0;
6900 insn |= rtra;
6901 return insn;
6902 }
6903
6904 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6905 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6906 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6907
6908 unsigned int
6909 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6910 {
6911 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6912 && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6913 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6914 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6915 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6916 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6917 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6918 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6919 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6920 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6921 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6922 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6923 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6924 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6925 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6926 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6927 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6928 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6929 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6930 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6931 {
6932 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6933 }
6934 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6935 && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6936 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6937 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6938 {
6939 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6940 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6941 if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6942 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6943 }
6944 else
6945 insn = 0;
6946 return insn;
6947 }
6948
6949 static bfd_boolean
6950 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6951 {
6952 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6953 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6954 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6955 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6956 }
6957
6958 static bfd_boolean
6959 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6960 {
6961 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6962 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6963 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6964 }
6965
6966 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6967 to handle the relocations for a section.
6968
6969 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6970 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6971 zero.
6972
6973 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6974 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6975 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6976 necessary.
6977
6978 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6979 address or the reloc symbol index.
6980
6981 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6982
6983 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6984 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6985
6986 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6987 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6988
6989 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6990 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6991 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6992 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6993 accordingly. */
6994
6995 static bfd_boolean
6996 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6997 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6998 bfd *input_bfd,
6999 asection *input_section,
7000 bfd_byte *contents,
7001 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7002 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7003 asection **local_sections)
7004 {
7005 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7006 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7007 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7008 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7009 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
7010 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7011 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
7012 asection *got2;
7013 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7014 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
7015 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7016 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
7017 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7018 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7019
7020 #ifdef DEBUG
7021 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7022 "%ld relocations%s",
7023 input_bfd, input_section,
7024 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7025 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7026 #endif
7027
7028 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7029 {
7030 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7031 return FALSE;
7032 }
7033
7034 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7035
7036 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7037 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7038 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7039
7040 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7041 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7042 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7043 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7044 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7045 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7046 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7047 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7048 ".tls_vars"));
7049 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7050 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7051 rel = wrel = relocs;
7052 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7053 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7054 {
7055 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7056 bfd_vma addend;
7057 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7058 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7059 asection *sec;
7060 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7061 const char *sym_name;
7062 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7063 unsigned long r_symndx;
7064 bfd_vma relocation;
7065 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7066 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7067 bfd_boolean warned;
7068 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7069 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7070 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7071
7072 again:
7073 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7074 sym = NULL;
7075 sec = NULL;
7076 h = NULL;
7077 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7078 warned = FALSE;
7079 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7080
7081 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7082 {
7083 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7084 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7085 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7086
7087 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7088 }
7089 else
7090 {
7091 bfd_boolean ignored;
7092
7093 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7094 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7095 h, sec, relocation,
7096 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7097
7098 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7099 }
7100
7101 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7102 {
7103 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7104 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7105 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7106 howto = NULL;
7107 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7108 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7109
7110 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7111 contents, rel->r_offset);
7112 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7113 wrel->r_info = 0;
7114 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7115
7116 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7117 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7118 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7119 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7120 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7121 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7122 wrel--;
7123
7124 continue;
7125 }
7126
7127 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7128 {
7129 if (got2 != NULL
7130 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7131 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7132 {
7133 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7134 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7135 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7136 }
7137 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7138 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7139 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7140 goto copy_reloc;
7141 }
7142
7143 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7144 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7145 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7146 for the final instruction stream. */
7147 tls_mask = 0;
7148 tls_gd = 0;
7149 if (h != NULL)
7150 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7151 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7152 {
7153 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7154 char *lgot_masks;
7155 local_plt
7156 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7157 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7158 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7159 }
7160
7161 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7162 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7163 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7164 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7165 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7166 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7167 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7168 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7169 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7170 abort ();
7171 switch (r_type)
7172 {
7173 default:
7174 break;
7175
7176 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7177 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7178 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7179 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7180 {
7181 bfd_vma insn;
7182
7183 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7184 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7185 insn &= 31 << 21;
7186 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7187 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7188 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7189 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7190 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7191 }
7192 break;
7193
7194 case R_PPC_TLS:
7195 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7196 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7197 {
7198 bfd_vma insn;
7199
7200 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7201 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7202 if (insn == 0)
7203 abort ();
7204 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7205 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7206 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7207
7208 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7209 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7210 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7211 }
7212 break;
7213
7214 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7215 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7216 tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
7217 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7218 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7219 break;
7220
7221 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7222 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7223 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7224 {
7225 tls_gdld_hi:
7226 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7227 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7228 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7229 else
7230 {
7231 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7232 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7233 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7234 }
7235 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7236 }
7237 break;
7238
7239 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7240 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7241 tls_gd = TLS_TPRELGD;
7242 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7243 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7244 break;
7245
7246 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7247 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7248 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7249 {
7250 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7251 bfd_vma offset;
7252
7253 tls_ldgd_opt:
7254 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7255 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7256 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7257 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7258 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7259 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7260 if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
7261 && rel + 1 < relend
7262 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7263 htab->tls_get_addr))
7264 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7265 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7266 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7267 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7268 intervening code. */
7269 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7270 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7271 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7272 {
7273 /* IE */
7274 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7275 insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7276 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7277 {
7278 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7279 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7280 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7281 }
7282 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7283 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7284 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7285 }
7286 else
7287 {
7288 /* LE */
7289 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7290 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7291 if (tls_gd == 0)
7292 {
7293 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7294 for (r_symndx = 0;
7295 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7296 r_symndx++)
7297 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7298 break;
7299 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7300 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7301 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7302 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7303 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7304 + sec->output_offset
7305 + sec->output_section->vma);
7306 }
7307 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7308 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7309 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7310 {
7311 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7312 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7313 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7314 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7315 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7316 }
7317 }
7318 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7319 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7320 if (tls_gd == 0)
7321 {
7322 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7323 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7324 goto again;
7325 }
7326 }
7327 break;
7328
7329 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7330 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7331 && rel + 1 < relend)
7332 {
7333 unsigned int insn2;
7334 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7335
7336 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7337 {
7338 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7339 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7340 break;
7341 }
7342
7343 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TPRELGD) != 0)
7344 {
7345 /* IE */
7346 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7347 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7348 }
7349 else
7350 {
7351 /* LE */
7352 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7353 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7354 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7355 }
7356 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7357 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7358 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7359 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7360 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7361 }
7362 break;
7363
7364 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7365 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7366 && rel + 1 < relend)
7367 {
7368 unsigned int insn2;
7369
7370 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7371 {
7372 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7373 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7374 break;
7375 }
7376
7377 for (r_symndx = 0;
7378 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7379 r_symndx++)
7380 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7381 break;
7382 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7383 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7384 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7385 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7386 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7387 + sec->output_offset
7388 + sec->output_section->vma);
7389
7390 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7391 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7392 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7393 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7394 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7395 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7396 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7397 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7398 goto again;
7399 }
7400 break;
7401 }
7402
7403 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7404 branch_bit = 0;
7405 switch (r_type)
7406 {
7407 default:
7408 break;
7409
7410 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7411 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7412 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7413 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7414 /* Fall through. */
7415
7416 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7417 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7418 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7419 {
7420 unsigned int insn;
7421
7422 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7423 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7424 insn |= branch_bit;
7425
7426 from = (rel->r_offset
7427 + input_section->output_offset
7428 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7429
7430 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7431 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7432 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7433
7434 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7435 }
7436 break;
7437
7438 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7439 {
7440 unsigned int insn;
7441
7442 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7443 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7444 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7445 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7446 {
7447 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7448 {
7449 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7450 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7451 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7452 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7453 }
7454 }
7455 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7456 info->callbacks->einfo
7457 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7458 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7459 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7460 }
7461 break;
7462 }
7463
7464 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7465 && h != NULL
7466 && !h->def_regular
7467 && h->protected_def
7468 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7469 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7470 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7471 {
7472 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7473 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7474 unsigned int insn;
7475
7476 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7477 {
7478 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7479 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7480 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7481 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7482 {
7483 bfd_byte *p;
7484 bfd_vma off;
7485 bfd_vma got_addr;
7486
7487 p = (contents + input_section->size
7488 - relax_info->workaround_size
7489 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7490 + picfixup_size);
7491 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7492 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7493 info->callbacks->einfo
7494 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7495 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7496
7497 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7498 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7499 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7500 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7501 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7502 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7503 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7504 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7505 insn &= ~0xffff;
7506 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7507 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7508
7509 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7510 insn &= ~0xffff;
7511 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7512 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7513 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7514 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7515
7516 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7517 picfixup_size += 12;
7518
7519 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7520 output is reasonable. */
7521 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7522 wrel++, rel++;
7523 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7524 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7525 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7526
7527 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7528 dynamic reloc. */
7529 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7530 }
7531 else
7532 _bfd_error_handler
7533 /* xgettext:c-format */
7534 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7535 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7536 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7537 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7538 }
7539 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7540 {
7541 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7542 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7543 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7544 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7545 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7546 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7547 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7548 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7549 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7550 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7551 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7552 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7553 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7554 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7555 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7556 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7557 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7558 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7559 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7560 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7561 {
7562 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7563 relocation = 0;
7564 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7565 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7566 }
7567 else
7568 _bfd_error_handler
7569 /* xgettext:c-format */
7570 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7571 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7572 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7573 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7574 }
7575 }
7576
7577 ifunc = NULL;
7578 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7579 {
7580 struct plt_entry *ent;
7581
7582 if (h != NULL)
7583 {
7584 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7585 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7586 }
7587 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7588 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7589 {
7590 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7591
7592 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7593 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7594 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7595 }
7596
7597 ent = NULL;
7598 if (ifunc != NULL
7599 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7600 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7601 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7602 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7603 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7604 {
7605 addend = 0;
7606 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7607 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7608 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7609 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7610 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7611 addend = rel->r_addend;
7612 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7613 }
7614 if (ent != NULL)
7615 {
7616 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7617 && ent->sec != got2
7618 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7619 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7620 || h == NULL
7621 || h->dynindx == -1))
7622 {
7623 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7624 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7625 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7626 apparently are using code compiled with
7627 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7628 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7629 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7630 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7631 into .got2). */
7632 info->callbacks->einfo
7633 /* xgettext:c-format */
7634 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7635 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7636 }
7637
7638 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7639 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7640 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7641 || h == NULL
7642 || h->dynindx == -1)
7643 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7644 + htab->glink->output_offset
7645 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7646 else
7647 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7648 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7649 + ent->plt.offset);
7650 }
7651 }
7652
7653 addend = rel->r_addend;
7654 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7655 howto = NULL;
7656 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7657 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7658
7659 switch (r_type)
7660 {
7661 default:
7662 break;
7663
7664 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7665 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7666 {
7667 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7668 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7669 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7670 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7671 /* xgettext:c-format */
7672 info->callbacks->minfo
7673 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7674 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7675 else
7676 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7677 }
7678 break;
7679
7680 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7681 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7682 {
7683 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7684 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7685 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7686 insn |= 2 << 16;
7687 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7688 }
7689 break;
7690 }
7691
7692 tls_type = 0;
7693 switch (r_type)
7694 {
7695 default:
7696 /* xgettext:c-format */
7697 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7698 input_bfd, howto->name);
7699
7700 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7701 ret = FALSE;
7702 goto copy_reloc;
7703
7704 case R_PPC_NONE:
7705 case R_PPC_TLS:
7706 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7707 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7708 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7709 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7710 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7711 goto copy_reloc;
7712
7713 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7714 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7715 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7716 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7717 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7718 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7719 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7720 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7721 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7722 goto dogot;
7723
7724 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7725 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7726 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7727 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7728 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7729 goto dogot;
7730
7731 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7732 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7733 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7734 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7735 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7736 goto dogot;
7737
7738 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7739 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7740 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7741 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7742 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7743 goto dogot;
7744
7745 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7746 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7747 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7748 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7749 tls_mask = 0;
7750 dogot:
7751 {
7752 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7753 offset table. */
7754 bfd_vma off;
7755 bfd_vma *offp;
7756 unsigned long indx;
7757
7758 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7759 abort ();
7760
7761 indx = 0;
7762 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7763 && (h == NULL
7764 || !h->def_dynamic))
7765 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7766 else if (h != NULL)
7767 {
7768 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7769 || h->dynindx == -1
7770 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7771 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7772 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7773 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7774 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7775 because of a version file. */
7776 ;
7777 else
7778 {
7779 indx = h->dynindx;
7780 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7781 }
7782 offp = &h->got.offset;
7783 }
7784 else
7785 {
7786 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7787 abort ();
7788 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7789 }
7790
7791 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7792 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7793 processed this entry. */
7794 off = *offp;
7795 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7796 off &= ~1;
7797 else
7798 {
7799 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7800 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7801 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)
7802 : 0);
7803
7804 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7805 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7806 else if (h == NULL
7807 || !h->def_dynamic)
7808 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7809
7810 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7811 Initialize them all. */
7812 do
7813 {
7814 int tls_ty = 0;
7815
7816 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7817 {
7818 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7819 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7820 }
7821 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7822 {
7823 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7824 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7825 }
7826 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7827 {
7828 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7829 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7830 }
7831 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_TPRELGD)) != 0)
7832 {
7833 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7834 tls_m = 0;
7835 }
7836
7837 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7838 if (indx != 0
7839 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7840 && (h == NULL
7841 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)
7842 || offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7843 && !(tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
7844 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7845 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7846 {
7847 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7848 bfd_byte * loc;
7849
7850 if (ifunc != NULL)
7851 {
7852 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7853 if (indx == 0)
7854 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7855 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7856 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7857 }
7858 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7859 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7860 + off);
7861 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7862 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7863 {
7864 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7865 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7866 {
7867 loc = rsec->contents;
7868 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7869 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7870 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7871 &outrel, loc);
7872 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7873 outrel.r_info
7874 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7875 }
7876 }
7877 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7878 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7879 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7880 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7881 else if (indx != 0)
7882 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7883 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7884 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7885 else
7886 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7887 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7888 {
7889 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7890 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7891 {
7892 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7893 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7894 else
7895 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7896 }
7897 }
7898 loc = rsec->contents;
7899 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7900 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7901 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7902 }
7903
7904 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7905 emitting a reloc. */
7906 else
7907 {
7908 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7909
7910 if (tls_ty != 0)
7911 {
7912 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7913 value = 0;
7914 else
7915 {
7916 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7917 value = 0;
7918 else
7919 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7920 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7921 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7922 }
7923
7924 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7925 {
7926 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7927 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7928 value = 1;
7929 }
7930 }
7931 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7932 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7933 }
7934
7935 off += 4;
7936 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7937 off += 4;
7938 }
7939 while (tls_m != 0);
7940
7941 off = *offp;
7942 *offp = off | 1;
7943 }
7944
7945 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7946 abort ();
7947
7948 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7949 {
7950 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7951 {
7952 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7953 && !(h == NULL
7954 || !h->def_dynamic))
7955 off += 8;
7956 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7957 {
7958 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7959 off += 8;
7960 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7961 {
7962 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7963 off += 4;
7964 }
7965 }
7966 }
7967 }
7968
7969 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7970 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7971 goto copy_reloc;
7972
7973 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7974 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7975 + off
7976 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7977
7978 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7979 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7980 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7981 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7982 if (addend != 0)
7983 info->callbacks->einfo
7984 /* xgettext:c-format */
7985 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7986 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7987 howto->name,
7988 sym_name);
7989 }
7990 break;
7991
7992 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7993 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7994 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7995 at a symbol not in this object. */
7996 if (unresolved_reloc)
7997 {
7998 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7999 h->root.root.string,
8000 input_bfd,
8001 input_section,
8002 rel->r_offset,
8003 TRUE);
8004 goto copy_reloc;
8005 }
8006 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
8007 {
8008 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
8009 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
8010 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
8011 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
8012 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
8013 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
8014 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
8015 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
8016 /* xgettext:c-format */
8017 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
8018 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8019 h->root.root.string);
8020 }
8021 break;
8022
8023 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8024 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8025 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8026 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8027 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8028 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8029 break;
8030
8031 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8032 object. */
8033 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8034 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8035 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8036 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8037 if (h != NULL
8038 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8039 && h->dynindx == -1)
8040 {
8041 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8042 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8043 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8044 defined before using them. */
8045 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8046 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8047 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8048 if (insn != 0)
8049 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8050 break;
8051 }
8052 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8053 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8054 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8055 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8056 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8057 goto dodyn;
8058
8059 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8060 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8061 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8062 goto dodyn;
8063
8064 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8065 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8066 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8067 goto dodyn;
8068
8069 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8070 relocation = 1;
8071 addend = 0;
8072 goto dodyn;
8073
8074 case R_PPC_REL16:
8075 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8076 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8077 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8078 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8079 break;
8080
8081 case R_PPC_REL32:
8082 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8083 break;
8084 /* fall through */
8085
8086 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8087 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8088 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8089 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8090 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8091 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8092 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8093 goto dodyn;
8094
8095 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8096 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8097 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8098 case R_PPC_REL24:
8099 case R_PPC_REL14:
8100 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8101 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8102 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8103 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8104 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8105 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8106 break;
8107 /* fall through */
8108
8109 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8110 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8111 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8112 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8113 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8114 break;
8115 /* fall through */
8116
8117 dodyn:
8118 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8119 || is_vxworks_tls)
8120 break;
8121
8122 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8123 ? ((h == NULL
8124 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8125 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8126 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8127 : (h != NULL
8128 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8129 {
8130 int skip;
8131 bfd_byte *loc;
8132 asection *sreloc;
8133 long indx = 0;
8134
8135 #ifdef DEBUG
8136 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8137 "create relocation for %s\n",
8138 (h && h->root.root.string
8139 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8140 #endif
8141
8142 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8143 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8144 time. */
8145 skip = 0;
8146 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8147 input_section,
8148 rel->r_offset);
8149 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8150 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8151 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8152 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8153 + input_section->output_offset);
8154
8155 if (skip)
8156 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8157 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8158 {
8159 indx = h->dynindx;
8160 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8161 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8162 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8163 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8164 }
8165 else
8166 {
8167 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8168
8169 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8170 {
8171 if (ifunc != NULL)
8172 {
8173 /* If we get here when building a static
8174 executable, then the libc startup function
8175 responsible for applying indirect function
8176 relocations is going to complain about
8177 the reloc type.
8178 If we get here when building a dynamic
8179 executable, it will be because we have
8180 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8181 will set the text segment writable and
8182 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8183 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8184 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8185 info->callbacks->einfo
8186 /* xgettext:c-format */
8187 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8188 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8189 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8190 howto->name,
8191 sym_name);
8192 ret = FALSE;
8193 }
8194 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8195 ;
8196 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8197 {
8198 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8199 ret = FALSE;
8200 }
8201 else
8202 {
8203 asection *osec;
8204
8205 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8206 against a section symbol. It would be
8207 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8208 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8209 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8210 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8211 osec = sec->output_section;
8212 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8213 {
8214 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8215 indx = 0;
8216 }
8217 else
8218 {
8219 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8220 if (indx == 0)
8221 {
8222 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8223 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8224 }
8225 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8226 }
8227
8228 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8229 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8230 addend for them. */
8231 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8232 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8233 }
8234
8235 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8236 }
8237 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8238 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8239 else
8240 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8241 }
8242
8243 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8244 if (ifunc)
8245 {
8246 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8247 if (indx == 0)
8248 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8249 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8250 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8251 }
8252 if (sreloc == NULL)
8253 return FALSE;
8254
8255 loc = sreloc->contents;
8256 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8257 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8258
8259 if (skip == -1)
8260 goto copy_reloc;
8261
8262 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8263 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8264 if (!skip)
8265 {
8266 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8267 addend = 0;
8268 break;
8269 }
8270 }
8271 break;
8272
8273 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8274 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8275 if (h != NULL)
8276 {
8277 struct plt_entry *ent;
8278 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8279
8280 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8281 {
8282 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8283 got2_addend = addend;
8284 addend = 0;
8285 }
8286 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8287 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8288 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8289 + htab->glink->output_offset
8290 + ent->glink_offset);
8291 else
8292 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8293 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8294 + ent->plt.offset);
8295 }
8296 /* Fall through. */
8297
8298 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8299 {
8300 const int *stub;
8301 size_t size;
8302 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8303 unsigned int insn;
8304
8305 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8306 {
8307 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8308 + input_section->output_offset
8309 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8310 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8311 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8312 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8313 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8314 stub += 3;
8315 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8316 }
8317 else
8318 {
8319 stub = stub_entry;
8320 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8321 }
8322
8323 relocation += addend;
8324 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8325 relocation = 0;
8326
8327 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8328 insn = *stub++;
8329 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8330 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8331 insn_offset += 4;
8332
8333 insn = *stub++;
8334 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8335 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8336 insn_offset += 4;
8337 size -= 2;
8338
8339 while (size != 0)
8340 {
8341 insn = *stub++;
8342 --size;
8343 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8344 insn_offset += 4;
8345 }
8346
8347 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8348 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8349 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8350 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8351 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8352 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8353 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8354 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8355 wrel++, rel++;
8356 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8357 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8358 }
8359 continue;
8360
8361 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8362 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8363 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8364 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8365 {
8366 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8367 break;
8368 }
8369 relocation
8370 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8371 h, relocation, rel);
8372 addend = 0;
8373 break;
8374
8375 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8376 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8377 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8378 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8379 {
8380 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8381 break;
8382 }
8383 relocation
8384 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8385 h, relocation, rel);
8386 addend = 0;
8387 break;
8388
8389 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8390 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8391 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8392 AIX .toc section. */
8393 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8394 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8395 {
8396 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8397 break;
8398 }
8399 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8400 ".got") == 0
8401 || strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8402 ".cgot") == 0);
8403
8404 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8405 break;
8406
8407 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8408 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8409 {
8410 struct plt_entry *ent;
8411
8412 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8413 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8414 if (ent == NULL
8415 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8416 {
8417 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8418 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8419 using -Bsymbolic. */
8420 }
8421 else
8422 {
8423 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8424 procedure linkage table. */
8425 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8426 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8427 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8428 + htab->glink->output_offset
8429 + ent->glink_offset);
8430 else
8431 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8432 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8433 + ent->plt.offset);
8434 }
8435 }
8436
8437 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8438 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8439 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8440 addend = 0;
8441 break;
8442
8443 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8444 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8445 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8446 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8447 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8448 plt_list = NULL;
8449 if (h != NULL)
8450 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8451 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8452 plt_list = ifunc;
8453 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8454 {
8455 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8456 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8457 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8458 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8459 }
8460 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8461 if (plt_list != NULL)
8462 {
8463 struct plt_entry *ent;
8464
8465 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8466 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8467 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8468 {
8469 asection *plt;
8470
8471 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8472 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8473 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8474 || h == NULL
8475 || h->dynindx == -1)
8476 {
8477 if (ifunc != NULL)
8478 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8479 else
8480 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8481 }
8482 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8483 + plt->output_offset
8484 + ent->plt.offset);
8485 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8486 {
8487 bfd_vma got = 0;
8488
8489 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8490 got = (ent->addend
8491 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8492 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8493 else
8494 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8495 relocation -= got;
8496 }
8497 }
8498 }
8499 addend = 0;
8500 break;
8501
8502 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8503 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8504 {
8505 const char *name;
8506 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8507
8508 if (sec == NULL
8509 || sec->output_section == NULL
8510 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8511 {
8512 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8513 break;
8514 }
8515 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8516
8517 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8518 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8519 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8520 {
8521 _bfd_error_handler
8522 /* xgettext:c-format */
8523 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8524 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8525 input_bfd,
8526 sym_name,
8527 howto->name,
8528 name);
8529 }
8530 }
8531 break;
8532
8533 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8534 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8535 {
8536 const char *name;
8537 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8538
8539 if (sec == NULL
8540 || sec->output_section == NULL
8541 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8542 {
8543 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8544 break;
8545 }
8546 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8547
8548 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8549 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8550 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8551 {
8552 _bfd_error_handler
8553 /* xgettext:c-format */
8554 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8555 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8556 input_bfd,
8557 sym_name,
8558 howto->name,
8559 name);
8560 }
8561 }
8562 break;
8563
8564 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8565 relocation = relocation + addend;
8566 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8567 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8568 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8569 goto copy_reloc;
8570
8571 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8572 relocation = relocation + addend;
8573 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8574 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8575 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8576 goto copy_reloc;
8577
8578 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8579 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8580 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8581 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8582 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8583 goto copy_reloc;
8584
8585 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8586 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8587 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8588 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8589 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8590 goto copy_reloc;
8591
8592 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8593 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8594 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8595 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8596 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8597 goto copy_reloc;
8598
8599 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8600 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8601 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8602 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8603 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8604 goto copy_reloc;
8605
8606 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8607 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8608 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8609 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8610 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8611 {
8612 const char *name;
8613 int reg;
8614 unsigned int insn;
8615 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8616
8617 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8618 {
8619 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8620 break;
8621 }
8622
8623 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8624 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8625 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8626 {
8627 reg = 13;
8628 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8629 }
8630 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8631 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8632 {
8633 reg = 2;
8634 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8635 }
8636 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8637 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8638 {
8639 reg = 0;
8640 }
8641 else
8642 {
8643 _bfd_error_handler
8644 /* xgettext:c-format */
8645 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8646 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8647 input_bfd,
8648 sym_name,
8649 howto->name,
8650 name);
8651
8652 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8653 ret = FALSE;
8654 goto copy_reloc;
8655 }
8656
8657 if (sda != NULL)
8658 {
8659 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8660 {
8661 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8662 break;
8663 }
8664 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8665 }
8666
8667 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8668 break;
8669
8670 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8671 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8672 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8673 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8674 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8675 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8676 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8677 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8678 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8679
8680 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8681 if (reg == 0
8682 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8683 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8684 {
8685 relocation = relocation + addend;
8686 addend = 0;
8687
8688 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8689 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8690 insn |= 28u << 26;
8691
8692 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8693 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8694 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8695 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8696 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8697 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8698 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8699
8700 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8701
8702 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8703 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8704 goto overflow;
8705 goto copy_reloc;
8706 }
8707 /* Fill in register field. */
8708 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8709 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8710 }
8711 break;
8712
8713 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8714 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8715 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8716 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8717 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8718 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8719 {
8720 bfd_vma value;
8721 const char *name;
8722 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8723
8724 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8725 {
8726 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8727 break;
8728 }
8729
8730 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8731 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8732 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8733 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8734 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8735 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8736 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8737 else
8738 {
8739 _bfd_error_handler
8740 /* xgettext:c-format */
8741 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8742 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8743 input_bfd,
8744 sym_name,
8745 howto->name,
8746 name);
8747
8748 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8749 ret = FALSE;
8750 goto copy_reloc;
8751 }
8752
8753 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8754 {
8755 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8756 break;
8757 }
8758 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8759
8760 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8761 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8762 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8763 split16a_type,
8764 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8765 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8766 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8767 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8768 split16d_type,
8769 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8770 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8771 {
8772 value = value >> 16;
8773 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8774 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8775 split16a_type,
8776 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8777 }
8778 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8779 {
8780 value = value >> 16;
8781 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8782 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8783 split16d_type,
8784 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8785 }
8786 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8787 {
8788 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8789 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8790 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8791 split16a_type,
8792 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8793 }
8794 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8795 {
8796 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8797 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8798 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8799 split16d_type,
8800 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8801 }
8802 }
8803 goto copy_reloc;
8804
8805 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8806 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8807 continue;
8808
8809 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8810 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8811 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8812 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8813 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8814 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8815 {
8816 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8817 break;
8818 }
8819 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8820 break;
8821
8822 /* Negative relocations. */
8823 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8824 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8825 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8826 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8827 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8828 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8829 break;
8830
8831 case R_PPC_COPY:
8832 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8833 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8834 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8835 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8836 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8837 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8838 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8839 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8840 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8841 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8842 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8843 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8844 /* xgettext:c-format */
8845 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8846 input_bfd, howto->name);
8847
8848 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8849 ret = FALSE;
8850 goto copy_reloc;
8851 }
8852
8853 switch (r_type)
8854 {
8855 default:
8856 break;
8857
8858 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8859 if (unresolved_reloc)
8860 {
8861 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8862 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8863 insn &= 1;
8864 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8865 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8866 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8867 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8868 }
8869 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8870 info->callbacks->einfo
8871 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8872 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8873 howto->name);
8874 break;
8875
8876 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8877 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8878 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8879 if (unresolved_reloc)
8880 {
8881 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8882 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8883 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8884 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8885 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8886 }
8887 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8888 info->callbacks->einfo
8889 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8890 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8891 howto->name);
8892 break;
8893 }
8894
8895 /* Do any further special processing. */
8896 switch (r_type)
8897 {
8898 default:
8899 break;
8900
8901 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8902 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8903 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8904 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8905 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8906 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8907 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8908 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8909 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8910 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8911 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8912 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8913 if (sec == NULL)
8914 break;
8915 /* Fall through. */
8916
8917 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8918 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8919 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8920 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8921 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8922 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8923 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8924 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8925 addend += 0x8000;
8926 break;
8927
8928 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8929 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8930 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8931 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8932 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8933 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8934 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8935 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8936 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8937 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8938 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8939 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8940 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8941 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8942 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8943 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8944 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8945 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8946 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8947 {
8948 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8949 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8950 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8951 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8952
8953 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8954 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8955 mask = 0;
8956 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8957 mask = 3;
8958 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8959 mask = 15;
8960 else
8961 break;
8962 relocation += addend;
8963 addend = insn & mask;
8964 lobit = mask & relocation;
8965 if (lobit != 0)
8966 {
8967 relocation ^= lobit;
8968 info->callbacks->einfo
8969 /* xgettext:c-format */
8970 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8971 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8972 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8973 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8974 ret = FALSE;
8975 }
8976 }
8977 break;
8978 }
8979
8980 #ifdef DEBUG
8981 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8982 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8983 howto->name,
8984 (int) r_type,
8985 sym_name,
8986 r_symndx,
8987 (long) rel->r_offset,
8988 (long) addend);
8989 #endif
8990
8991 if (unresolved_reloc
8992 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8993 && h->def_dynamic)
8994 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8995 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8996 {
8997 info->callbacks->einfo
8998 /* xgettext:c-format */
8999 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
9000 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9001 howto->name,
9002 sym_name);
9003 ret = FALSE;
9004 }
9005
9006 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9007 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9008 have different reloc types. */
9009 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9010 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9011 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
9012 {
9013 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9014
9015 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9016 {
9017 unsigned int insn;
9018
9019 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9020 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9021 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9022 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9023 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9024 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9025 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9026 }
9027 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9028 {
9029 alt_howto = *howto;
9030 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9031 howto = &alt_howto;
9032 }
9033 }
9034
9035 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9036 {
9037 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9038 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9039 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9040 else
9041 {
9042 unsigned int insn;
9043
9044 relocation += addend;
9045 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9046 + input_section->output_offset
9047 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9048 relocation >>= 16;
9049 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9050 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9051 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9052 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9053 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9054 }
9055 }
9056 else
9057 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9058 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9059
9060 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9061 {
9062 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9063 {
9064 overflow:
9065 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9066 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9067 if (!warned
9068 && !(h != NULL
9069 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9070 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9071 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9072 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9073 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9074 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9075 }
9076 else
9077 {
9078 info->callbacks->einfo
9079 /* xgettext:c-format */
9080 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9081 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9082 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9083 ret = FALSE;
9084 }
9085 }
9086 copy_reloc:
9087 if (wrel != rel)
9088 *wrel = *rel;
9089 }
9090
9091 if (wrel != rel)
9092 {
9093 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9094 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9095
9096 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9097 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9098 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9099 {
9100 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9101 one NONE reloc.
9102 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9103 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9104 deleted -= 1;
9105 wrel++;
9106 }
9107 relend = wrel;
9108 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9109 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9110 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9111 }
9112
9113 #ifdef DEBUG
9114 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9115 #endif
9116
9117 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9118 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9119 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9120 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9121 {
9122 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9123 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9124 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9125 }
9126
9127 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9128 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9129 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9130 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9131 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9132 {
9133 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9134 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9135
9136 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9137 {
9138 bfd_byte *p;
9139 unsigned int n;
9140 bfd_byte fill[4];
9141
9142 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9143 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9144 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9145 while (n--)
9146 {
9147 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9148 p += 4;
9149 }
9150 }
9151
9152 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9153 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9154 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9155 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9156 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9157
9158 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9159 + input_section->output_offset);
9160 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9161 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9162 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9163 addr < end_addr;
9164 addr += pagesize)
9165 {
9166 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9167 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9168 bfd_boolean is_data;
9169 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9170 unsigned int insn;
9171
9172 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9173 the word alone. */
9174 is_data = FALSE;
9175 lo = relocs;
9176 hi = relend;
9177 rel = NULL;
9178 while (lo < hi)
9179 {
9180 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9181 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9182 lo = rel + 1;
9183 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9184 hi = rel;
9185 else
9186 {
9187 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9188 {
9189 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9190 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9191 case R_PPC_REL32:
9192 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9193 is_data = TRUE;
9194 break;
9195 default:
9196 break;
9197 }
9198 break;
9199 }
9200 }
9201 if (is_data)
9202 continue;
9203
9204 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9205 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9206 avoid the icache failure.
9207
9208 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9209 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9210 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9211 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9212 unconditional branches:
9213 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9214 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9215 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9216 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9217 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9218 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9219 instruction is not executed.
9220
9221 A bctr example:
9222 .
9223 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9224 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9225 . mtctr 9
9226 . bctr
9227 . nop
9228 . nop
9229 . new_page:
9230 .
9231 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9232 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9233 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9234 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9235 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9236 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9237 place:
9238 .
9239 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9240 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9241 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9242 . bctr bctr
9243 . nop b somewhere_else
9244 . b somewhere_else nop
9245 . new_page: new_page:
9246 . */
9247 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9248 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9249 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9250 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9251 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9252 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9253 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9254 continue;
9255
9256 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9257 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9258 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9259 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9260 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9261
9262 if (rel != NULL
9263 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9264 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9265 {
9266 asection *sreloc;
9267
9268 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9269 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9270 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9271 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9272 {
9273 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9274
9275 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9276 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9277 relend[-1] = tmp;
9278 }
9279 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9280
9281 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9282 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9283 {
9284 case R_PPC_REL16:
9285 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9286 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9287 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9288 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9289 break;
9290 default:
9291 break;
9292 }
9293
9294 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9295 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9296 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9297 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9298 if (sreloc != NULL)
9299 {
9300 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9301 bfd_vma soffset;
9302
9303 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9304 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9305 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9306 + input_section->output_offset);
9307 while (slo < shi)
9308 {
9309 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9310 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9311 &outrel);
9312 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9313 slo = srel + 1;
9314 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9315 shi = srel;
9316 else
9317 {
9318 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9319 {
9320 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9321 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9322 srel = srelend - 1;
9323 }
9324 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9325 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9326 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9327 break;
9328 }
9329 }
9330 }
9331 }
9332 else
9333 rel = NULL;
9334
9335 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9336 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9337 {
9338 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9339
9340 delta += offset - patch_off;
9341 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9342 delta = 0;
9343 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9344 {
9345 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9346
9347 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9348 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9349 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9350 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9351 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9352 else
9353 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9354
9355 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9356 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9357 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9358 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9359 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9360 }
9361 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9362 {
9363 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9364 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9365 contents + patch_off);
9366 patch_off += 4;
9367 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9368 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9369 contents + patch_off);
9370 patch_off += 4;
9371 }
9372 else
9373 {
9374 if (rel != NULL)
9375 {
9376 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9377
9378 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9379 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9380 }
9381 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9382 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9383 contents + patch_off);
9384 patch_off += 4;
9385 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9386 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9387 contents + patch_off);
9388 patch_off += 4;
9389 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9390 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9391 contents + patch_off);
9392 patch_off += 4;
9393 }
9394 }
9395 else
9396 {
9397 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9398 patch_off += 4;
9399 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9400 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9401 contents + patch_off);
9402 patch_off += 4;
9403 }
9404 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9405 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9406 }
9407 }
9408
9409 return ret;
9410 }
9411 \f
9412 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9413
9414 static bfd_boolean
9415 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9416 {
9417 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9418 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9419 struct plt_entry *ent;
9420 bfd_boolean doneone;
9421
9422 doneone = FALSE;
9423 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9424 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9425 {
9426 if (!doneone)
9427 {
9428 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9429 bfd_byte *loc;
9430 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9431 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9432 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9433
9434 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9435 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9436 || h->dynindx == -1)
9437 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9438 else
9439 {
9440 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9441 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9442 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9443 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9444 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9445 }
9446
9447 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9448 Set it up. */
9449 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9450 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9451 && h->dynindx != -1)
9452 {
9453 bfd_vma got_offset;
9454 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9455
9456 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9457 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9458
9459 /* Use the right PLT. */
9460 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9461 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9462
9463 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9464 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9465 {
9466 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9467 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9468 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9469 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9470 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9471 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9472 }
9473 else
9474 {
9475 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9476
9477 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9478 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9479 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9480 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9481 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9482 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9483 }
9484
9485 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9486 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9487 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9488 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9489
9490 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9491 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9492 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9493 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9494 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9495 prescaled offset. */
9496 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9497 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9498 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9499 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9500 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9501 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9502 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9503 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9504 offset. */
9505 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9506 (plt_entry[5]
9507 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9508 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9509 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9510 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9511 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9512 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9513
9514 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9515 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9516 in this PLT entry. */
9517 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9518 + plt->output_offset
9519 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9520 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9521
9522 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9523 {
9524 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9525 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9526 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9527 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9528 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9529
9530 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9531 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9532 + plt->output_offset
9533 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9534 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9535 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9536 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9537 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9538 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9539
9540 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9541 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9542 + plt->output_offset
9543 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9544 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9545 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9546 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9547 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9548 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9549
9550 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9551 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9552 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9553 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9554 + got_offset);
9555 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9556 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9557 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9558 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9559 }
9560
9561 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9562 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9563 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9564 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9565 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9566 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9567 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9568 + got_offset);
9569 rela.r_addend = 0;
9570 }
9571 else
9572 {
9573 rela.r_addend = 0;
9574 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9575 || h->dynindx == -1)
9576 {
9577 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9578 {
9579 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9580 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9581 }
9582 else
9583 {
9584 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9585 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9586 }
9587 if (h->def_regular
9588 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9589 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9590 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9591 }
9592
9593 if (relplt == NULL)
9594 {
9595 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9596 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9597 }
9598 else
9599 {
9600 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9601 + plt->output_offset
9602 + ent->plt.offset);
9603
9604 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9605 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9606 || h->dynindx == -1)
9607 {
9608 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9609 linker will fill it in. */
9610 }
9611 else
9612 {
9613 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9614 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9615 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9616 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9617 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9618 }
9619 }
9620 }
9621
9622 if (relplt != NULL)
9623 {
9624 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9625 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9626 || h->dynindx == -1)
9627 {
9628 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9629 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9630 else
9631 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9632 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9633 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9634 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9635 }
9636 else
9637 {
9638 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9639 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9640 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9641 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9642 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9643 }
9644 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9645 }
9646 doneone = TRUE;
9647 }
9648
9649 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9650 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9651 || h->dynindx == -1)
9652 {
9653 unsigned char *p;
9654 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9655
9656 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9657 || h->dynindx == -1)
9658 {
9659 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9660 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9661 else
9662 break;
9663 }
9664
9665 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9666 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9667
9668 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9669 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9670 break;
9671 }
9672 else
9673 break;
9674 }
9675 return TRUE;
9676 }
9677
9678 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9679
9680 bfd_boolean
9681 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9682 {
9683 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9684 bfd *ibfd;
9685
9686 if (!htab)
9687 return TRUE;
9688
9689 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9690
9691 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9692 {
9693 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9694 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9695 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9696 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9697 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9698 struct plt_entry *ent;
9699
9700 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9701 continue;
9702
9703 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9704 if (!local_got)
9705 continue;
9706
9707 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9708 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9709 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9710 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9711 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9712 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9713 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9714 {
9715 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9716 {
9717 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9718 asection *sym_sec;
9719 asection *plt, *relplt;
9720 bfd_byte *loc;
9721 bfd_vma val;
9722 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9723 unsigned char *p;
9724
9725 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9726 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9727 {
9728 if (local_syms != NULL
9729 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9730 free (local_syms);
9731 return FALSE;
9732 }
9733
9734 val = sym->st_value;
9735 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9736 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9737
9738 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9739 {
9740 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9741 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9742 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9743 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9744 }
9745 else
9746 {
9747 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9748 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9749 {
9750 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9751 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9752 }
9753 else
9754 {
9755 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9756 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9757 continue;
9758 }
9759 }
9760
9761 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9762 + plt->output_offset
9763 + plt->output_section->vma);
9764 rela.r_addend = val;
9765 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9766 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9767 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9768
9769 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9770 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9771 }
9772 }
9773
9774 if (local_syms != NULL
9775 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9776 {
9777 if (!info->keep_memory)
9778 free (local_syms);
9779 else
9780 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9781 }
9782 }
9783 return TRUE;
9784 }
9785
9786 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9787 dynamic sections here. */
9788
9789 static bfd_boolean
9790 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9791 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9792 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9793 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9794 {
9795 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9796 struct plt_entry *ent;
9797
9798 #ifdef DEBUG
9799 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9800 h->root.root.string);
9801 #endif
9802
9803 if (!h->def_regular
9804 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9805 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9806 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9807 {
9808 if (!h->def_regular)
9809 {
9810 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9811 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9812 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9813 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9814 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9815 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9816 to zero. */
9817 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9818 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9819 sym->st_value = 0;
9820 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9821 {
9822 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9823 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9824 function pointer. */
9825 sym->st_value = 0;
9826 }
9827 }
9828 else
9829 {
9830 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9831 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9832 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9833 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9834 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9835 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9836 relocation. */
9837 sym->st_shndx
9838 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9839 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9840 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9841 + htab->glink->output_offset
9842 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9843 }
9844 break;
9845 }
9846
9847 if (h->needs_copy)
9848 {
9849 asection *s;
9850 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9851 bfd_byte *loc;
9852
9853 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9854
9855 #ifdef DEBUG
9856 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9857 #endif
9858
9859 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9860
9861 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9862 s = htab->relsbss;
9863 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9864 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9865 else
9866 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9867 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9868
9869 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9870 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9871 rela.r_addend = 0;
9872 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9873 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9874 }
9875
9876 #ifdef DEBUG
9877 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9878 #endif
9879
9880 return TRUE;
9881 }
9882 \f
9883 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9884 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9885 const asection *rel_sec,
9886 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9887 {
9888 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9889
9890 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9891 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9892
9893 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9894 {
9895 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9896 return reloc_class_relative;
9897 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9898 return reloc_class_plt;
9899 case R_PPC_COPY:
9900 return reloc_class_copy;
9901 default:
9902 return reloc_class_normal;
9903 }
9904 }
9905 \f
9906 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9907
9908 static bfd_boolean
9909 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9910 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9911 {
9912 asection *sdyn;
9913 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9914 bfd_vma got;
9915 bfd *dynobj;
9916 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9917
9918 #ifdef DEBUG
9919 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9920 #endif
9921
9922 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9923 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9924 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9925
9926 got = 0;
9927 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9928 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9929
9930 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9931 {
9932 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9933
9934 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9935
9936 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9937 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9938 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9939 {
9940 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9941 asection *s;
9942
9943 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9944
9945 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9946 {
9947 case DT_PLTGOT:
9948 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9949 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9950 else
9951 s = htab->elf.splt;
9952 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9953 break;
9954
9955 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9956 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9957 break;
9958
9959 case DT_JMPREL:
9960 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9961 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9962 break;
9963
9964 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9965 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9966 break;
9967
9968 case DT_TEXTREL:
9969 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9970 info->callbacks->einfo
9971 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9972 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9973 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9974 info->callbacks->einfo
9975 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9976 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9977 continue;
9978
9979 default:
9980 if (htab->is_vxworks
9981 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9982 break;
9983 continue;
9984 }
9985
9986 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9987 }
9988 }
9989
9990 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9991 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9992 {
9993 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9994 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9995 {
9996 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9997
9998 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9999 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
10000 {
10001 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10002 so that a function can easily find the address of
10003 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10004 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10005 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10006 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10007 }
10008
10009 if (sdyn != NULL)
10010 {
10011 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10012 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10013 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10014 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10015 }
10016 }
10017 else
10018 {
10019 /* xgettext:c-format */
10020 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10021 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10022 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10023 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10024 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10025 ret = FALSE;
10026 }
10027
10028 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10029 }
10030
10031 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10032 if (htab->is_vxworks
10033 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10034 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10035 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10036 {
10037 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10038 /* Use the right PLT. */
10039 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10040 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10041 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10042
10043 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10044 {
10045 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10046
10047 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10048 splt->contents + 0);
10049 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10050 splt->contents + 4);
10051 }
10052 else
10053 {
10054 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10055 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10056 }
10057 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10058 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10059 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10060 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10061 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10062 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10063
10064 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10065 {
10066 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10067 bfd_byte *loc;
10068
10069 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10070
10071 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10072 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10073 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10074 + 2);
10075 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10076 rela.r_addend = 0;
10077 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10078 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10079
10080 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10081 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10082 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10083 + 6);
10084 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10085 rela.r_addend = 0;
10086 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10087 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10088
10089 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10090 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10091 in which symbols were output. */
10092 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10093 {
10094 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10095
10096 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10097 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10098 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10099 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10100
10101 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10102 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10103 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10104 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10105
10106 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10107 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10108 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10109 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10110 }
10111 }
10112 }
10113
10114 if (htab->glink != NULL
10115 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10116 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10117 {
10118 unsigned char *p;
10119 unsigned char *endp;
10120 bfd_vma res0;
10121
10122 /*
10123 * PIC glink code is the following:
10124 *
10125 * # ith PLT code stub.
10126 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10127 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10128 * mtctr 11
10129 * bctr
10130 *
10131 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10132 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10133 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10134 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10135 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10136 * .
10137 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10138 * res_n_m3: nop
10139 * res_n_m2: nop
10140 * res_n_m1:
10141 *
10142 * PLTresolve:
10143 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10144 * mflr 0
10145 * bcl 20,31,1f
10146 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10147 * mflr 12
10148 * mtlr 0
10149 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10150 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10151 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10152 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10153 * mtctr 0
10154 * add 0,11,11
10155 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10156 * bctr
10157 *
10158 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10159 *
10160 * # ith PLT code stub.
10161 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10162 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10163 * mtctr 11
10164 * bctr
10165 *
10166 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10167 *
10168 * PLTresolve:
10169 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10170 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10171 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10172 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10173 * mtctr 0
10174 * add 0,11,11
10175 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10176 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10177 * bctr
10178 */
10179
10180 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10181 and perhaps some padding. */
10182 p = htab->glink->contents;
10183 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10184 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10185 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10186 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10187 {
10188 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10189 p += 4;
10190 }
10191 while (p < endp)
10192 {
10193 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10194 p += 4;
10195 }
10196
10197 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10198 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10199 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10200
10201 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10202 {
10203 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10204 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10205 glink branch table. */
10206 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10207 bfd_vma page_addr;
10208 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10209 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10210
10211 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10212 page_addr > glink_start;
10213 page_addr -= pagesize)
10214 {
10215 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10216 bfd_byte *loc;
10217 unsigned int insn;
10218
10219 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10220 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10221 if (insn == BCTR)
10222 {
10223 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10224 one other call stub before this one. */
10225 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10226 if (insn == BCTR)
10227 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10228 else
10229 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10230 }
10231 }
10232 }
10233
10234 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10235 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10236 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10237 {
10238 bfd_vma bcl;
10239
10240 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10241 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10242 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10243
10244 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10245 p += 4;
10246 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10247 p += 4;
10248 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10249 p += 4;
10250 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10251 p += 4;
10252 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10253 p += 4;
10254 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10255 p += 4;
10256 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10257 p += 4;
10258 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10259 p += 4;
10260 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10261 {
10262 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10263 p += 4;
10264 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10265 p += 4;
10266 }
10267 else
10268 {
10269 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10270 p += 4;
10271 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10272 p += 4;
10273 }
10274 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10275 p += 4;
10276 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10277 }
10278 else
10279 {
10280 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10281 p += 4;
10282 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10283 p += 4;
10284 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10285 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10286 else
10287 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10288 p += 4;
10289 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10290 p += 4;
10291 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10292 p += 4;
10293 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10294 p += 4;
10295 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10296 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10297 else
10298 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10299 }
10300 p += 4;
10301 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10302 p += 4;
10303 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10304 p += 4;
10305 while (p < endp)
10306 {
10307 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10308 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10309 p += 4;
10310 }
10311 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10312 }
10313
10314 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10315 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10316 {
10317 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10318 bfd_vma val;
10319
10320 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10321 /* FDE length. */
10322 p += 4;
10323 /* CIE pointer. */
10324 p += 4;
10325 /* Offset to .glink. */
10326 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10327 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10328 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10329 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10330 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10331 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10332
10333 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10334 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10335 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10336 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10337 return FALSE;
10338 }
10339
10340 return ret;
10341 }
10342 \f
10343 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10344 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10345 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10346 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10347 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10348 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10349 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10350 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10351 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10352 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10353 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10354
10355 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10356 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10357 #endif
10358
10359 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10360 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10361 #endif
10362
10363 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10364 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10365 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10366 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10367 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10368 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10369
10370 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10371 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10372 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10373 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10374 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10375 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10376 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10377 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10378
10379 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10380 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10381 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10382 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10383 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10384 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10385 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10386 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10387 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10388 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10389 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10390 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10391 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10392 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10393 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10394 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10395 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10396 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10397 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10398 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10399 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10400 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10401 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10402 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10403 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10404 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10405 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10406 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10407 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10408
10409 #include "elf32-target.h"
10410
10411 /* FreeBSD Target */
10412
10413 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10414 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10415
10416 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10417 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10418 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10419 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10420
10421 #undef ELF_OSABI
10422 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10423
10424 #undef elf32_bed
10425 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10426
10427 #include "elf32-target.h"
10428
10429 /* VxWorks Target */
10430
10431 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10432 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10433
10434 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10435 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10436 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10437 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10438
10439 #undef ELF_OSABI
10440
10441 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10442 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10443 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10444 {
10445 if (sec->name == NULL)
10446 return NULL;
10447
10448 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10449 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10450
10451 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10452 }
10453
10454 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10455 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10456 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10457 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10458 {
10459 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10460
10461 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10462 if (ret)
10463 {
10464 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10465 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10466 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10467 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10468 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10469 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10470 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10471 }
10472 return ret;
10473 }
10474
10475 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10476 static bfd_boolean
10477 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10478 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10479 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10480 const char **namep,
10481 flagword *flagsp,
10482 asection **secp,
10483 bfd_vma *valp)
10484 {
10485 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10486 valp))
10487 return FALSE;
10488
10489 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10490 }
10491
10492 static void
10493 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker)
10494 {
10495 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
10496 elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
10497 }
10498
10499 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10500 define it. */
10501 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10502 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10503 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10504 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10505 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10506 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10507 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10508 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10509 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10510 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10511 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10512 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10513 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10514 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10515
10516 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10517
10518 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10519 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10520 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10521 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10522 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10523 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10524 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10525 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10526 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10527 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10528 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10529 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10530 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10531 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10532 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10533 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10534 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10535 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10536
10537 #undef elf32_bed
10538 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10539 #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
10540
10541 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.318074 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.